OpenCores
URL https://opencores.org/ocsvn/or1k/or1k/trunk

Subversion Repositories or1k

[/] [or1k/] [trunk/] [gdb-5.0/] [gdb/] [doc/] [gdb.texinfo] - Blame information for rev 1774

Go to most recent revision | Details | Compare with Previous | View Log

Line No. Rev Author Line
1 106 markom
\input texinfo      @c -*-texinfo-*-
2
@c Copyright 1988-2000
3
@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
@c
5
@c %**start of header
6
@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7
@c of @set vars.  However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8
@setfilename gdb.info
9
@c
10
@include gdb-cfg.texi
11
@c
12
@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
13
@setchapternewpage odd
14
@c %**end of header
15
 
16
@iftex
17
@c @smallbook
18
@c @cropmarks
19
@end iftex
20
 
21
@finalout
22
@syncodeindex ky cp
23
 
24
@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
25
@c annotate.texi uses @findex.
26
@syncodeindex vr cp
27
@syncodeindex fn cp
28
 
29
@c gdbmi uses @findex
30
@syncodeindex fn cp
31
 
32
@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
33
@set EDITION Eighth
34
 
35
@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
36
@set DATE March 2000
37
 
38
@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
39
 
40
@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41
@c manuals to an info tree.
42
@dircategory Programming & development tools.
43
@direntry
44
* Gdb: (gdb).                     The @sc{gnu} debugger.
45
@end direntry
46
 
47
@ifinfo
48
This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
49
 
50
 
51
This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
52
of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
53
for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
54
 
55
Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
56
 
57
Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
58
this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
59
are preserved on all copies.
60
 
61
@ignore
62
Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
63
results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
64
notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
65
(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
66
 
67
@end ignore
68
Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
69
manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
70
entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
71
permission notice identical to this one.
72
 
73
Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
74
into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
75
@end ifinfo
76
 
77
@titlepage
78
@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79
@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80
@sp 1
81
@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82
@subtitle @value{DATE}
83
@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et.al.
84
@page
85
@tex
86
{\parskip=0pt
87
\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
88
\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
89
\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
90
}
91
@end tex
92
 
93
@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
94
Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
95
@sp 2
96
Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
97
59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
98
Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
99
ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
100
 
101
Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
102
this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
103
are preserved on all copies.
104
 
105
Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
106
manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
107
entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
108
permission notice identical to this one.
109
 
110
Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
111
into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
112
@end titlepage
113
@page
114
 
115
@ifinfo
116
@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
117
 
118
@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
119
 
120
This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
121
 
122
This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
123
@value{GDBVN}.
124
 
125
Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
126
 
127
@menu
128
* Summary::                     Summary of @value{GDBN}
129
* Sample Session::              A sample @value{GDBN} session
130
 
131
* Invocation::                  Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
132
* Commands::                    @value{GDBN} commands
133
* Running::                     Running programs under @value{GDBN}
134
* Stopping::                    Stopping and continuing
135
* Stack::                       Examining the stack
136
* Source::                      Examining source files
137
* Data::                        Examining data
138
 
139
* Languages::                   Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
140
 
141
* Symbols::                     Examining the symbol table
142
* Altering::                    Altering execution
143
* GDB Files::                   @value{GDBN} files
144
* Targets::                     Specifying a debugging target
145
* Configurations::              Configuration-specific information
146
* Controlling GDB::             Controlling @value{GDBN}
147
* Sequences::                   Canned sequences of commands
148
* Emacs::                       Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
149
* Annotations::                 @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
150
* GDB/MI::                      @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
151
 
152
* GDB Bugs::                    Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
153
* Formatting Documentation::    How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
154
 
155
* Command Line Editing::        Command Line Editing
156
* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
157
* Installing GDB::              Installing GDB
158
* Index::                       Index
159
@end menu
160
 
161
@end ifinfo
162
 
163
@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
164
 
165
@ifhtml
166
@node Top
167
 
168
@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
169
 
170
This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
171
 
172
This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
173
@value{GDBVN}.
174
 
175
Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
176
 
177
@menu
178
* Summary::                     Summary of @value{GDBN}
179
* Sample Session::              A sample @value{GDBN} session
180
 
181
* Invocation::                  Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
182
* Commands::                    @value{GDBN} commands
183
* Running::                     Running programs under @value{GDBN}
184
* Stopping::                    Stopping and continuing
185
* Stack::                       Examining the stack
186
* Source::                      Examining source files
187
* Data::                        Examining data
188
 
189
* Languages::                   Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
190
 
191
* Symbols::                     Examining the symbol table
192
* Altering::                    Altering execution
193
* GDB Files::                   @value{GDBN} files
194
* Targets::                     Specifying a debugging target
195
* Configurations::              Configuration-specific information
196
* Controlling GDB::             Controlling @value{GDBN}
197
* Sequences::                   Canned sequences of commands
198
* Emacs::                       Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
199
* Annotations::                 @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
200
 
201
* GDB Bugs::                    Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
202
* Formatting Documentation::    How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
203
 
204
* Command Line Editing::        Command Line Editing
205
* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
206
* Installing GDB::              Installing GDB
207
* Index::                       Index
208
@end menu
209
 
210
@end ifhtml
211
 
212
@node Summary
213
@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
214
 
215
The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
216
going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
217
program was doing at the moment it crashed.
218
 
219
@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
220
these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
221
 
222
@itemize @bullet
223
@item
224
Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
225
 
226
@item
227
Make your program stop on specified conditions.
228
 
229
@item
230
Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
231
 
232
@item
233
Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
234
effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
235
@end itemize
236
 
237
You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
238
For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
239
For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
240
 
241
@cindex Chill
242
@cindex Modula-2
243
Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial.  For information on Modula-2,
244
see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.  For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
245
 
246
@cindex Pascal
247
Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
248
nested functions does not currently work.  @value{GDBN} does not support
249
entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
250
syntax.
251
 
252
@cindex Fortran
253
@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
254
it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
255
underscore.
256
 
257
@menu
258
* Free Software::               Freely redistributable software
259
* Contributors::                Contributors to GDB
260
@end menu
261
 
262
@node Free Software
263
@unnumberedsec Free software
264
 
265
@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
266
General Public License
267
(GPL).  The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
268
program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
269
freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
270
the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
271
Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
272
Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
273
 
274
Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
275
you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
276
from anyone else.
277
 
278
@node Contributors
279
@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
280
 
281
Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
282
other @sc{gnu} programs.  Many others have contributed to its
283
development.  This section attempts to credit major contributors.  One
284
of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
285
to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here.  The
286
file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
287
blow-by-blow account.
288
 
289
Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
290
 
291
@quotation
292
@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome.  If you
293
or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
294
omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
295
@end quotation
296
 
297
So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
298
particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
299
releases:
300
Andrew Cagney (release 5.0);
301
Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
302
Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
303
Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
304
Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
305
Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
306
John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
307
Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
308
and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
309
 
310
Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
311
Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
312
 
313
Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in
314
@value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
315
Bothner.  James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler.  Early work on
316
C++ was by Peter TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading
317
to release 3.0).
318
 
319
@value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
320
object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
321
Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
322
 
323
David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
324
the original support for encapsulated COFF.
325
 
326
Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
327
 
328
Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
329
Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
330
support.
331
Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
332
Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
333
Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
334
David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
335
Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
336
Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
337
Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
338
Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
339
Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
340
Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
341
Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
342
Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
343
Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
344
Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
345
Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
346
 
347
Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
348
 
349
Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
350
libraries.
351
 
352
Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
353
about several machine instruction sets.
354
 
355
Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
356
remote debugging.  Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
357
contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
358
and RDI targets, respectively.
359
 
360
Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
361
command-line editing and command history.
362
 
363
Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
364
Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
365
 
366
Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
367
He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
368
symbols.
369
 
370
Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
371
Super-H processors.
372
 
373
NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
374
 
375
Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
376
 
377
Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
378
 
379
Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
380
 
381
Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
382
 
383
Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
384
watchpoints.
385
 
386
Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
387
 
388
Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
389
 
390
Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
391
nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
392
 
393
The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
394
support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
395
(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
396
compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
397
John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
398
Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni.  Kim Haase provided HP-specific
399
information in this manual.
400
 
401
Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
402
development since 1991.  Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
403
fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
404
Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
405
Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
406
Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
407
Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni.  In
408
addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
409
JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
410
Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
411
Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
412
Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
413
Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
414
Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
415
Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
416
 
417
 
418
@node Sample Session
419
@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
420
 
421
You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
422
However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
423
debugger.  This chapter illustrates those commands.
424
 
425
@iftex
426
In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
427
to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
428
@end iftex
429
 
430
@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
431
@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
432
 
433
One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
434
processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
435
quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
436
definition within another stop working.  In the following short @code{m4}
437
session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
438
then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
439
same thing.  However, when we change the open quote string to
440
@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
441
procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
442
 
443
@smallexample
444
$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
445
$ @b{./m4}
446
@b{define(foo,0000)}
447
 
448
@b{foo}
449
0000
450
@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
451
 
452
@b{bar}
453
0000
454
@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
455
 
456
@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
457
@b{baz}
458
@b{C-d}
459
m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
460
@end smallexample
461
 
462
@noindent
463
Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
464
 
465
@smallexample
466
$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
467
@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
468
@c FIXME... format to come out better.
469
@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
470
 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
471
 the conditions.
472
There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
473
 for details.
474
 
475
@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
476
(@value{GDBP})
477
@end smallexample
478
 
479
@noindent
480
@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
481
rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
482
We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
483
that examples fit in this manual.
484
 
485
@smallexample
486
(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
487
@end smallexample
488
 
489
@noindent
490
We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
491
Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
492
@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
493
@code{break} command.
494
 
495
@smallexample
496
(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
497
Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
498
@end smallexample
499
 
500
@noindent
501
Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
502
control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
503
subroutine, the program runs as usual:
504
 
505
@smallexample
506
(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
507
Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
508
@b{define(foo,0000)}
509
 
510
@b{foo}
511
0000
512
@end smallexample
513
 
514
@noindent
515
To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}.  @value{GDBN}
516
suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
517
context where it stops.
518
 
519
@smallexample
520
@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
521
 
522
Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
523
    at builtin.c:879
524
879         if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
525
@end smallexample
526
 
527
@noindent
528
Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
529
the next line of the current function.
530
 
531
@smallexample
532
(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533
882         set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
534
 : nil,
535
@end smallexample
536
 
537
@noindent
538
@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine.  We can go into it
539
by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
540
@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
541
subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
542
 
543
@smallexample
544
(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
545
set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
546
    at input.c:530
547
530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
548
@end smallexample
549
 
550
@noindent
551
The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
552
suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display.  It
553
shows a summary of the stack.  We can use the @code{backtrace}
554
command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
555
in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
556
stack frame for each active subroutine.
557
 
558
@smallexample
559
(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
560
#0  set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
561
    at input.c:530
562
#1  0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
563
    at builtin.c:882
564
#2  0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
565
#3  0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
566
    at macro.c:71
567
#4  0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
568
#5  0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
569
@end smallexample
570
 
571
@noindent
572
We step through a few more lines to see what happens.  The first two
573
times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
574
falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
575
 
576
@smallexample
577
(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
578
0x3b5c  532         if (rquote != def_rquote)
579
(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
580
0x3b80  535         lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ?  \
581
def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
582
(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
583
536         rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
584
 : xstrdup(rq);
585
(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
586
538         len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
587
@end smallexample
588
 
589
@noindent
590
The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
591
@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
592
and right quotes we specified.  We use the command @code{p}
593
(@code{print}) to see their values.
594
 
595
@smallexample
596
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
597
$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
598
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
599
$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
600
@end smallexample
601
 
602
@noindent
603
@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
604
To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
605
surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
606
 
607
@smallexample
608
(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
609
533             xfree(rquote);
610
534
611
535         lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
612
 : xstrdup (lq);
613
536         rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
614
 : xstrdup (rq);
615
537
616
538         len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
617
539         len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
618
540     @}
619
541
620
542     void
621
@end smallexample
622
 
623
@noindent
624
Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
625
@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
626
 
627
@smallexample
628
(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629
539         len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
630
(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631
540     @}
632
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
633
$3 = 9
634
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
635
$4 = 7
636
@end smallexample
637
 
638
@noindent
639
That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
640
@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
641
@code{rquote} respectively.  We can set them to better values using
642
the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
643
any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
644
assignments.
645
 
646
@smallexample
647
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
648
$5 = 7
649
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
650
$6 = 9
651
@end smallexample
652
 
653
@noindent
654
Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
655
@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}?  We can allow @code{m4} to continue
656
executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
657
example that caused trouble initially:
658
 
659
@smallexample
660
(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
661
Continuing.
662
 
663
@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
664
 
665
baz
666
0000
667
@end smallexample
668
 
669
@noindent
670
Success!  The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones.  The
671
problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
672
lengths.  We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
673
 
674
@smallexample
675
@b{C-d}
676
Program exited normally.
677
@end smallexample
678
 
679
@noindent
680
The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
681
indicates @code{m4} has finished executing.  We can end our @value{GDBN}
682
session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
683
 
684
@smallexample
685
(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
686
@end smallexample
687
 
688
@node Invocation
689
@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
690
 
691
This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
692
The essentials are:
693
@itemize @bullet
694
@item
695
type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
696
@item
697
type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
698
@end itemize
699
 
700
@menu
701
* Invoking GDB::                How to start @value{GDBN}
702
* Quitting GDB::                How to quit @value{GDBN}
703
* Shell Commands::              How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
704
@end menu
705
 
706
@node Invoking GDB
707
@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
708
 
709
Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}.  Once started,
710
@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
711
 
712
You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
713
to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
714
 
715
The command-line options described here are designed
716
to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
717
options may effectively be unavailable.
718
 
719
The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
720
specifying an executable program:
721
 
722
@example
723
@value{GDBP} @var{program}
724
@end example
725
 
726
@noindent
727
You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
728
specified:
729
 
730
@example
731
@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
732
@end example
733
 
734
You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
735
to debug a running process:
736
 
737
@example
738
@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
739
@end example
740
 
741
@noindent
742
would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
743
named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
744
 
745
Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
746
complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
747
debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
748
``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump.  @value{GDBN}
749
will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
750
 
751
You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
752
@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
753
 
754
@smallexample
755
@value{GDBP} -silent
756
@end smallexample
757
 
758
@noindent
759
You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
760
options.  @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
761
 
762
@noindent
763
Type
764
 
765
@example
766
@value{GDBP} -help
767
@end example
768
 
769
@noindent
770
to display all available options and briefly describe their use
771
(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
772
 
773
All options and command line arguments you give are processed
774
in sequential order.  The order makes a difference when the
775
@samp{-x} option is used.
776
 
777
 
778
@menu
779
* File Options::                Choosing files
780
* Mode Options::                Choosing modes
781
@end menu
782
 
783
@node File Options
784
@subsection Choosing files
785
 
786
When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
787
specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID).  This is
788
the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
789
@samp{-c} options respectively.  (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
790
that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
791
@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
792
that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
793
the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
794
 
795
If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
796
such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
797
argument and ignore it.
798
 
799
Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
800
following list.  @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
801
them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
802
(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
803
than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
804
 
805
@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE.  This
806
@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
807
@c it.
808
 
809
@table @code
810
@item -symbols @var{file}
811
@itemx -s @var{file}
812
@cindex @code{--symbols}
813
@cindex @code{-s}
814
Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
815
 
816
@item -exec @var{file}
817
@itemx -e @var{file}
818
@cindex @code{--exec}
819
@cindex @code{-e}
820
Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
821
and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
822
 
823
@item -se @var{file}
824
@cindex @code{--se}
825
Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
826
file.
827
 
828
@item -core @var{file}
829
@itemx -c @var{file}
830
@cindex @code{--core}
831
@cindex @code{-c}
832
Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
833
 
834
@item -c @var{number}
835
Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
836
(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
837
case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
838
 
839
@item -command @var{file}
840
@itemx -x @var{file}
841
@cindex @code{--command}
842
@cindex @code{-x}
843
Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.  @xref{Command
844
Files,, Command files}.
845
 
846
@item -directory @var{directory}
847
@itemx -d @var{directory}
848
@cindex @code{--directory}
849
@cindex @code{-d}
850
Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
851
 
852
@item -m
853
@itemx -mapped
854
@cindex @code{--mapped}
855
@cindex @code{-m}
856
@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
857
supported on all systems.}@*
858
If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
859
system call, you can use this option
860
to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
861
program into a reusable file in the current directory.  If the program you are debugging is
862
called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
863
Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
864
and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
865
the symbol table from the executable program.
866
 
867
The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
868
is run.  It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
869
table.  It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
870
 
871
@item -r
872
@itemx -readnow
873
@cindex @code{--readnow}
874
@cindex @code{-r}
875
Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
876
the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
877
This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
878
 
879
@end table
880
 
881
You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
882
order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
883
information.  (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
884
on @file{.syms} files.)  A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
885
but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
886
 
887
@example
888
gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
889
@end example
890
 
891
@node Mode Options
892
@subsection Choosing modes
893
 
894
You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
895
batch mode or quiet mode.
896
 
897
@table @code
898
@item -nx
899
@itemx -n
900
@cindex @code{--nx}
901
@cindex @code{-n}
902
Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
903
called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs).  Normally,
904
@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
905
options and arguments have been processed.  @xref{Command Files,,Command
906
files}.
907
 
908
@item -quiet
909
@itemx -silent
910
@itemx -q
911
@cindex @code{--quiet}
912
@cindex @code{--silent}
913
@cindex @code{-q}
914
``Quiet''.  Do not print the introductory and copyright messages.  These
915
messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
916
 
917
@item -batch
918
@cindex @code{--batch}
919
Run in batch mode.  Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
920
command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
921
initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}).  Exit with
922
nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
923
in the command files.
924
 
925
Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
926
example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
927
make this more useful, the message
928
 
929
@example
930
Program exited normally.
931
@end example
932
 
933
@noindent
934
(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
935
@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
936
mode.
937
 
938
@item -nowindows
939
@itemx -nw
940
@cindex @code{--nowindows}
941
@cindex @code{-nw}
942
``No windows''.  If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
943
(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
944
interface.  If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
945
 
946
@item -windows
947
@itemx -w
948
@cindex @code{--windows}
949
@cindex @code{-w}
950
If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
951
used if possible.
952
 
953
@item -cd @var{directory}
954
@cindex @code{--cd}
955
Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
956
instead of the current directory.
957
 
958
@item -fullname
959
@itemx -f
960
@cindex @code{--fullname}
961
@cindex @code{-f}
962
@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
963
subprocess.  It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
964
number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
965
displayed (which includes each time your program stops).  This
966
recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
967
the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
968
and a newline.  The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
969
@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
970
frame.
971
 
972
@item -epoch
973
@cindex @code{--epoch}
974
The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
975
@value{GDBN} as a subprocess.  It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
976
routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
977
separate window.
978
 
979
@item -annotate @var{level}
980
@cindex @code{--annotate}
981
This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}.  Its
982
effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
983
(@pxref{Annotations}).
984
Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
985
together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
986
types of output.  Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
987
@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
988
maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
989
 
990
@item -async
991
@cindex @code{--async}
992
Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
993
@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
994
special event loop.  This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
995
commands in parallel with the debugged process being
996
run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
997
MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
998
suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
999
control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1000
(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.0, the target side of the asynchronous
1001
operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1002
yet.)
1003
@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1004
@c should be removed.
1005
 
1006
When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1007
uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1008
@samp{-noasync} option.
1009
 
1010
@item -noasync
1011
@cindex @code{--noasync}
1012
Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1013
 
1014
@item -baud @var{bps}
1015
@itemx -b @var{bps}
1016
@cindex @code{--baud}
1017
@cindex @code{-b}
1018
Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1019
interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1020
 
1021
@item -tty @var{device}
1022
@itemx -t @var{device}
1023
@cindex @code{--tty}
1024
@cindex @code{-t}
1025
Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1026
@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty.  Investigate.
1027
 
1028
@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1029
@c @item -tui
1030
@c @cindex @code{--tui}
1031
@c Use a Terminal User Interface.  For information, use your Web browser to
1032
@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1033
@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems.  Do not use
1034
@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1035
@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1036
 
1037
@c @item -xdb
1038
@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1039
@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1040
@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1041
@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1042
@c systems.
1043
 
1044
@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1045
@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1046
Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1047
program or device.  This option is meant to be set by programs which
1048
communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.  For example,
1049
@samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
1050
interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}).
1051
 
1052
@item -write
1053
@cindex @code{--write}
1054
Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing.  This
1055
is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1056
(@pxref{Patching}).
1057
 
1058
@item -statistics
1059
@cindex @code{--statistics}
1060
This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1061
memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1062
 
1063
@item -version
1064
@cindex @code{--version}
1065
This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1066
no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1067
 
1068
@end table
1069
 
1070
@node Quitting GDB
1071
@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1072
@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1073
@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1074
 
1075
@table @code
1076
@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1077
@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1078
@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1079
@itemx q
1080
To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1081
@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}).  If you
1082
do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1083
otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1084
error code.
1085
@end table
1086
 
1087
@cindex interrupt
1088
An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1089
terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1090
returns to @value{GDBN} command level.  It is safe to type the interrupt
1091
character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1092
until a time when it is safe.
1093
 
1094
If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1095
device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1096
(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1097
 
1098
@node Shell Commands
1099
@section Shell commands
1100
 
1101
If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1102
debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1103
just use the @code{shell} command.
1104
 
1105
@table @code
1106
@kindex shell
1107
@cindex shell escape
1108
@item shell @var{command string}
1109
Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1110
If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1111
shell to run.  Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1112
(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1113
@end table
1114
 
1115
The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1116
You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1117
@value{GDBN}:
1118
 
1119
@table @code
1120
@kindex make
1121
@cindex calling make
1122
@item make @var{make-args}
1123
Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1124
arguments.  This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1125
@end table
1126
 
1127
@node Commands
1128
@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1129
 
1130
You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1131
name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1132
@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}.  You can also use the @key{TAB}
1133
key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1134
show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1135
 
1136
@menu
1137
* Command Syntax::              How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1138
* Completion::                  Command completion
1139
* Help::                        How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1140
@end menu
1141
 
1142
@node Command Syntax
1143
@section Command syntax
1144
 
1145
A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input.  There is no limit on
1146
how long it can be.  It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1147
arguments whose meaning depends on the command name.  For example, the
1148
command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1149
step, as in @samp{step 5}.  You can also use the @code{step} command
1150
with no arguments.  Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1151
 
1152
@cindex abbreviation
1153
@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1154
unambiguous.  Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1155
documentation for individual commands.  In some cases, even ambiguous
1156
abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1157
equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1158
names start with @code{s}.  You can test abbreviations by using them as
1159
arguments to the @code{help} command.
1160
 
1161
@cindex repeating commands
1162
@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1163
A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1164
repeat the previous command.  Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1165
will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1166
repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1167
repeat.
1168
 
1169
The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1170
@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1171
exactly as typed.  This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1172
 
1173
@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1174
output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1175
(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}).  Since it is easy to press one
1176
@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1177
repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1178
 
1179
@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1180
@cindex comment
1181
Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1182
nothing.  This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1183
Files,,Command files}).
1184
 
1185
@node Completion
1186
@section Command completion
1187
 
1188
@cindex completion
1189
@cindex word completion
1190
@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1191
only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1192
are for the next word in a command, at any time.  This works for @value{GDBN}
1193
commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1194
 
1195
Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1196
of a word.  If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1197
word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1198
enter it).  For example, if you type
1199
 
1200
@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1201
@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1202
@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1203
@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1204
@example
1205
(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1206
@end example
1207
 
1208
@noindent
1209
@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1210
the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1211
 
1212
@example
1213
(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1214
@end example
1215
 
1216
@noindent
1217
You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1218
breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1219
@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected.  (If you
1220
were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1221
might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1222
to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1223
 
1224
If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1225
@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell.  You can either supply more
1226
characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1227
@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word.  For
1228
example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1229
begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1230
just sounds the bell.  Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1231
function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1232
example:
1233
 
1234
@example
1235
(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1236
@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1237
make_a_section_from_file     make_environ
1238
make_abs_section             make_function_type
1239
make_blockvector             make_pointer_type
1240
make_cleanup                 make_reference_type
1241
make_command                 make_symbol_completion_list
1242
(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1243
@end example
1244
 
1245
@noindent
1246
After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1247
partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1248
command.
1249
 
1250
If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1251
can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1252
means @kbd{@key{META} ?}.  You can type this either by holding down a
1253
key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1254
one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1255
 
1256
@cindex quotes in commands
1257
@cindex completion of quoted strings
1258
Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1259
parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1260
its notion of a word.  To permit word completion to work in this
1261
situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1262
@value{GDBN} commands.
1263
 
1264
The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1265
name of a C++ function.  This is because C++ allows function overloading
1266
(multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1267
type).  For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1268
distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1269
@code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1270
@code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.  To use the word-completion
1271
facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1272
beginning of the function name.  This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1273
consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1274
@kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1275
 
1276
@example
1277
(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1278
bubble(double,double)    bubble(int,int)
1279
(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1280
@end example
1281
 
1282
In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1283
quotes.  When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1284
completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1285
place:
1286
 
1287
@example
1288
(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1289
@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1290
(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1291
@end example
1292
 
1293
@noindent
1294
In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1295
you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1296
completion on an overloaded symbol.
1297
 
1298
For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1299
expressions, ,C++ expressions}.  You can use the command @code{set
1300
overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1301
see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
1302
 
1303
 
1304
@node Help
1305
@section Getting help
1306
@cindex online documentation
1307
@kindex help
1308
 
1309
You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1310
using the command @code{help}.
1311
 
1312
@table @code
1313
@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1314
@item help
1315
@itemx h
1316
You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1317
display a short list of named classes of commands:
1318
 
1319
@smallexample
1320
(@value{GDBP}) help
1321
List of classes of commands:
1322
 
1323
aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1324
breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1325
data -- Examining data
1326
files -- Specifying and examining files
1327
internals -- Maintenance commands
1328
obscure -- Obscure features
1329
running -- Running the program
1330
stack -- Examining the stack
1331
status -- Status inquiries
1332
support -- Support facilities
1333
tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1334
               stopping the program
1335
user-defined -- User-defined commands
1336
 
1337
Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1338
commands in that class.
1339
Type "help" followed by command name for full
1340
documentation.
1341
Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1342
(@value{GDBP})
1343
@end smallexample
1344
@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1345
 
1346
@item help @var{class}
1347
Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1348
list of the individual commands in that class.  For example, here is the
1349
help display for the class @code{status}:
1350
 
1351
@smallexample
1352
(@value{GDBP}) help status
1353
Status inquiries.
1354
 
1355
List of commands:
1356
 
1357
@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1358
@c to fit in smallbook page size.
1359
info -- Generic command for showing things
1360
 about the program being debugged
1361
show -- Generic command for showing things
1362
 about the debugger
1363
 
1364
Type "help" followed by command name for full
1365
documentation.
1366
Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1367
(@value{GDBP})
1368
@end smallexample
1369
 
1370
@item help @var{command}
1371
With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1372
short paragraph on how to use that command.
1373
 
1374
@kindex apropos
1375
@item apropos @var{args}
1376
The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1377
commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1378
@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1379
 
1380
@smallexample
1381
apropos reload
1382
@end smallexample
1383
 
1384
@noindent results in:
1385
 
1386
@smallexample
1387
@c @group
1388
set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1389
                                 multiple times in one run
1390
show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1391
                                 multiple times in one run
1392
@c @end group
1393
@end smallexample
1394
 
1395
@kindex complete
1396
@item complete @var{args}
1397
The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1398
for the beginning of a command.  Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1399
command you want completed.  For example:
1400
 
1401
@smallexample
1402
complete i
1403
@end smallexample
1404
 
1405
@noindent results in:
1406
 
1407
@smallexample
1408
@group
1409
if
1410
ignore
1411
info
1412
inspect
1413
@end group
1414
@end smallexample
1415
 
1416
@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1417
@end table
1418
 
1419
In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1420
and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1421
of @value{GDBN} itself.  Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1422
manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context.  The listings
1423
under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1424
all the sub-commands.  @xref{Index}.
1425
 
1426
@c @group
1427
@table @code
1428
@kindex info
1429
@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1430
@item info
1431
This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1432
program.  For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1433
with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1434
registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1435
You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1436
@w{@code{help info}}.
1437
 
1438
@kindex set
1439
@item set
1440
You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1441
@code{set}.  For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1442
@code{set prompt $}.
1443
 
1444
@kindex show
1445
@item show
1446
In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1447
@value{GDBN} itself.
1448
You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1449
related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1450
system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1451
which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1452
 
1453
@kindex info set
1454
To display all the settable parameters and their current
1455
values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1456
@code{info set}.  Both commands produce the same display.
1457
@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1458
@c FIXME...program.  Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1459
@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1460
@end table
1461
@c @end group
1462
 
1463
Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1464
exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1465
 
1466
@table @code
1467
@kindex show version
1468
@cindex version number
1469
@item show version
1470
Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running.  You should include this
1471
information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports.  If multiple versions of
1472
@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1473
version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1474
commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away.  Also, many
1475
system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1476
variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1477
The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1478
@value{GDBN}.
1479
 
1480
@kindex show copying
1481
@item show copying
1482
Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1483
 
1484
@kindex show warranty
1485
@item show warranty
1486
Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1487
if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1488
 
1489
@end table
1490
 
1491
@node Running
1492
@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1493
 
1494
When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1495
debugging information when you compile it.
1496
 
1497
You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1498
of your choice.  If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1499
your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1500
kill a child process.
1501
 
1502
@menu
1503
* Compilation::                 Compiling for debugging
1504
* Starting::                    Starting your program
1505
* Arguments::                   Your program's arguments
1506
* Environment::                 Your program's environment
1507
 
1508
* Working Directory::           Your program's working directory
1509
* Input/Output::                Your program's input and output
1510
* Attach::                      Debugging an already-running process
1511
* Kill Process::                Killing the child process
1512
 
1513
* Threads::                     Debugging programs with multiple threads
1514
* Processes::                   Debugging programs with multiple processes
1515
@end menu
1516
 
1517
@node Compilation
1518
@section Compiling for debugging
1519
 
1520
In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1521
debugging information when you compile it.  This debugging information
1522
is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1523
variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1524
and addresses in the executable code.
1525
 
1526
To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1527
the compiler.
1528
 
1529
Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1530
options together.  Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1531
executables containing debugging information.
1532
 
1533
@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1534
without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code.  We
1535
recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1536
program.  You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1537
in pushing your luck.
1538
 
1539
@cindex optimized code, debugging
1540
@cindex debugging optimized code
1541
When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1542
optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1543
really there.  Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1544
exactly match your source file!  An extreme example: if you define a
1545
variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1546
variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1547
 
1548
Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1549
@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling.  If in
1550
doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1551
please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1552
 
1553
Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1554
@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information.  @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1555
format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1556
 
1557
@need 2000
1558
@node Starting
1559
@section Starting your program
1560
@cindex starting
1561
@cindex running
1562
 
1563
@table @code
1564
@kindex run
1565
@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1566
@item run
1567
@itemx r
1568
Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1569
You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1570
argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1571
@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1572
(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1573
 
1574
@end table
1575
 
1576
If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1577
supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1578
that process run your program.  (In environments without processes,
1579
@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1580
 
1581
The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1582
receives from its superior.  @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1583
information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program.  (You
1584
can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1585
your program the next time you start it.)  This information may be
1586
divided into four categories:
1587
 
1588
@table @asis
1589
@item The @emph{arguments.}
1590
Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1591
@code{run} command.  If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1592
is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1593
(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1594
the arguments.
1595
In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1596
@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1597
@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1598
 
1599
@item The @emph{environment.}
1600
Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1601
use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1602
environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1603
your program.  @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1604
 
1605
@item The @emph{working directory.}
1606
Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}.  You can set
1607
the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1608
@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1609
 
1610
@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1611
Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1612
standard output as @value{GDBN} is using.  You can redirect input and output
1613
in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1614
set a different device for your program.
1615
@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1616
 
1617
@cindex pipes
1618
@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1619
pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1620
program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1621
wrong program.
1622
@end table
1623
 
1624
When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1625
immediately.  @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1626
of how to arrange for your program to stop.  Once your program has
1627
stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1628
or @code{call} commands.  @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1629
 
1630
If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1631
time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1632
table, and reads it again.  When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1633
your current breakpoints.
1634
 
1635
@node Arguments
1636
@section Your program's arguments
1637
 
1638
@cindex arguments (to your program)
1639
The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1640
@code{run} command.
1641
They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1642
performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program.  Your
1643
@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1644
@value{GDBN} uses.  If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1645
the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1646
 
1647
On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1648
@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1649
calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1650
the program, not by the shell.
1651
 
1652
@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1653
@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1654
 
1655
@table @code
1656
@kindex set args
1657
@item set args
1658
Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run.  If
1659
@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1660
with no arguments.  Once you have run your program with arguments,
1661
using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1662
it again without arguments.
1663
 
1664
@kindex show args
1665
@item show args
1666
Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1667
@end table
1668
 
1669
@node Environment
1670
@section Your program's environment
1671
 
1672
@cindex environment (of your program)
1673
The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1674
their values.  Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1675
your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1676
path for programs to run.  Usually you set up environment variables with
1677
the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run.  When
1678
debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1679
environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1680
 
1681
@table @code
1682
@kindex path
1683
@item path @var{directory}
1684
Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1685
(the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
1686
You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1687
system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1688
MS-DOS and MS-Windows).  If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1689
is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1690
 
1691
You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1692
working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path.  If you
1693
use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1694
@code{path} command.  @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1695
@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1696
@var{directory} to the search path.
1697
@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1698
@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1699
 
1700
@kindex show paths
1701
@item show paths
1702
Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1703
environment variable).
1704
 
1705
@kindex show environment
1706
@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1707
Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1708
your program when it starts.  If you do not supply @var{varname},
1709
print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1710
your program.  You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1711
 
1712
@kindex set environment
1713
@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1714
Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}.  The value
1715
changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself.  @var{value} may
1716
be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1717
any interpretation is supplied by your program itself.  The @var{value}
1718
parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1719
null value.
1720
@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1721
@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1722
 
1723
For example, this command:
1724
 
1725
@example
1726
set env USER = foo
1727
@end example
1728
 
1729
@noindent
1730
tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1731
@samp{foo}.  (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1732
are not actually required.)
1733
 
1734
@kindex unset environment
1735
@item unset environment @var{varname}
1736
Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1737
program.  This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1738
@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1739
rather than assigning it an empty value.
1740
@end table
1741
 
1742
@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1743
the shell indicated
1744
by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1745
@code{/bin/sh} if not).  If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1746
that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1747
@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1748
your program.  You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1749
files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1750
@file{.profile}.
1751
 
1752
@node Working Directory
1753
@section Your program's working directory
1754
 
1755
@cindex working directory (of your program)
1756
Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1757
working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1758
The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1759
from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1760
working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1761
 
1762
The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1763
that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.  @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1764
specify files}.
1765
 
1766
@table @code
1767
@kindex cd
1768
@item cd @var{directory}
1769
Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1770
 
1771
@kindex pwd
1772
@item pwd
1773
Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1774
@end table
1775
 
1776
@node Input/Output
1777
@section Your program's input and output
1778
 
1779
@cindex redirection
1780
@cindex i/o
1781
@cindex terminal
1782
By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1783
the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses.  @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1784
to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1785
modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1786
running your program.
1787
 
1788
@table @code
1789
@kindex info terminal
1790
@item info terminal
1791
Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1792
program is using.
1793
@end table
1794
 
1795
You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1796
redirection with the @code{run} command.  For example,
1797
 
1798
@example
1799
run > outfile
1800
@end example
1801
 
1802
@noindent
1803
starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1804
 
1805
@kindex tty
1806
@cindex controlling terminal
1807
Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1808
with the @code{tty} command.  This command accepts a file name as
1809
argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1810
commands.  It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1811
process, for future @code{run} commands.  For example,
1812
 
1813
@example
1814
tty /dev/ttyb
1815
@end example
1816
 
1817
@noindent
1818
directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1819
default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1820
that as their controlling terminal.
1821
 
1822
An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1823
effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1824
terminal.
1825
 
1826
When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1827
command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected.  The input
1828
for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1829
 
1830
@node Attach
1831
@section Debugging an already-running process
1832
@kindex attach
1833
@cindex attach
1834
 
1835
@table @code
1836
@item attach @var{process-id}
1837
This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1838
outside @value{GDBN}.  (@code{info files} shows your active
1839
targets.)  The command takes as argument a process ID.  The usual way to
1840
find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1841
or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1842
 
1843
@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1844
executing the command.
1845
@end table
1846
 
1847
To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1848
which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1849
programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system.  You must
1850
also have permission to send the process a signal.
1851
 
1852
When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1853
the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1854
the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1855
(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}).  You can also use
1856
the @code{file} command to load the program.  @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1857
Specify Files}.
1858
 
1859
The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1860
process is to stop it.  You can examine and modify an attached process
1861
with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1862
you start processes with @code{run}.  You can insert breakpoints; you
1863
can step and continue; you can modify storage.  If you would rather the
1864
process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1865
attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1866
 
1867
@table @code
1868
@kindex detach
1869
@item detach
1870
When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1871
@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.  Detaching
1872
the process continues its execution.  After the @code{detach} command,
1873
that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1874
are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1875
@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1876
executing the command.
1877
@end table
1878
 
1879
If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1880
attached process, you kill that process.  By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1881
for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1882
control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1883
confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1884
messages}).
1885
 
1886
@node Kill Process
1887
@section Killing the child process
1888
 
1889
@table @code
1890
@kindex kill
1891
@item kill
1892
Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1893
@end table
1894
 
1895
This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1896
running process.  @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1897
is running.
1898
 
1899
On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1900
while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}.  You can use the
1901
@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1902
outside the debugger.
1903
 
1904
The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1905
relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1906
executable file while it is running in a process.  In this case, when you
1907
next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1908
reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1909
breakpoint settings).
1910
 
1911
@node Threads
1912
@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
1913
 
1914
@cindex threads of execution
1915
@cindex multiple threads
1916
@cindex switching threads
1917
In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1918
may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution.  The precise semantics
1919
of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1920
the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1921
that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1922
modify the same variables).  On the other hand, each thread has its own
1923
registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1924
 
1925
@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1926
programs:
1927
 
1928
@itemize @bullet
1929
@item automatic notification of new threads
1930
@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1931
@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1932
@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1933
a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1934
@item thread-specific breakpoints
1935
@end itemize
1936
 
1937
@quotation
1938
@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1939
@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1940
If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1941
effect.  For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1942
from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1943
like this:
1944
 
1945
@smallexample
1946
(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1947
(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1948
Thread ID 1 not known.  Use the "info threads" command to
1949
see the IDs of currently known threads.
1950
@end smallexample
1951
@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1952
@c                        doesn't support threads"?
1953
@end quotation
1954
 
1955
@cindex focus of debugging
1956
@cindex current thread
1957
The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1958
threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1959
control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1960
This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}.  Debugging commands show
1961
program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1962
 
1963
@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
1964
@cindex thread identifier (system)
1965
@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1966
@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1967
@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1968
Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1969
the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1970
form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}.  @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1971
whose form varies depending on the particular system.  For example, on
1972
LynxOS, you might see
1973
 
1974
@example
1975
[New process 35 thread 27]
1976
@end example
1977
 
1978
@noindent
1979
when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.  In contrast, on an SGI system,
1980
the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1981
further qualifier.
1982
 
1983
@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1984
@c         thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1985
@c         second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1986
@c         program?
1987
@c         (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always?  Or do some
1988
@c         multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1989
@c         threads ab initio?
1990
 
1991
@cindex thread number
1992
@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1993
For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1994
number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1995
 
1996
@table @code
1997
@kindex info threads
1998
@item info threads
1999
Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2000
program.  @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2001
 
2002
@enumerate
2003
@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2004
 
2005
@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2006
 
2007
@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2008
@end enumerate
2009
 
2010
@noindent
2011
An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2012
indicates the current thread.
2013
 
2014
For example,
2015
@end table
2016
@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2017
 
2018
@smallexample
2019
(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2020
  3 process 35 thread 27  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2021
  2 process 35 thread 23  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2022
* 1 process 35 thread 13  main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2023
    at threadtest.c:68
2024
@end smallexample
2025
 
2026
On HP-UX systems:
2027
 
2028
@cindex thread number
2029
@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2030
For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2031
number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2032
thread in your program.
2033
 
2034
@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2035
@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2036
@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2037
@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2038
@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2039
Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2040
both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2041
form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}.  @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2042
whose form varies depending on the particular system.  For example, on
2043
HP-UX, you see
2044
 
2045
@example
2046
[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2047
@end example
2048
 
2049
@noindent
2050
when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2051
 
2052
@table @code
2053
@kindex info threads
2054
@item info threads
2055
Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2056
program.  @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2057
 
2058
@enumerate
2059
@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2060
 
2061
@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2062
 
2063
@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2064
@end enumerate
2065
 
2066
@noindent
2067
An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2068
indicates the current thread.
2069
 
2070
For example,
2071
@end table
2072
@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2073
 
2074
@example
2075
(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2076
    * 3 system thread 26607  worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2077
                               at quicksort.c:137
2078
      2 system thread 26606  0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2079
                               from /usr/lib/libc.2
2080
      1 system thread 27905  0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2081
                               from /usr/lib/libc.2
2082
@end example
2083
 
2084
@table @code
2085
@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2086
@item thread @var{threadno}
2087
Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread.  The command
2088
argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2089
shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2090
@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2091
you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2092
 
2093
@smallexample
2094
@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2095
(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2096
[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2097
0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2098
@end smallexample
2099
 
2100
@noindent
2101
As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2102
@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2103
threads.
2104
 
2105
@kindex thread apply
2106
@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}]  @var{args}
2107
The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2108
more threads.  Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2109
with the command argument @var{threadno}.  @var{threadno} is the internal
2110
@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2111
threads} display.  To apply a command to all threads, use
2112
@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2113
@end table
2114
 
2115
@cindex automatic thread selection
2116
@cindex switching threads automatically
2117
@cindex threads, automatic switching
2118
Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2119
signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2120
signal happened.  @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2121
message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2122
thread.
2123
 
2124
@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2125
more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2126
programs with multiple threads.
2127
 
2128
@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2129
watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2130
 
2131
@node Processes
2132
@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2133
 
2134
@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2135
@cindex multiple processes
2136
@cindex processes, multiple
2137
On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2138
programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2139
function.  When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2140
parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.  If you have
2141
set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2142
will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2143
will cause it to terminate.
2144
 
2145
However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2146
which isn't too painful.  Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2147
the child process executes after the fork.  It may be useful to sleep
2148
only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2149
so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2150
on the child.  While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2151
get its process ID.  Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2152
@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2153
the child process (@pxref{Attach}).  From that point on you can debug
2154
the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2155
 
2156
On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2157
debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2158
@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2159
 
2160
By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2161
the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2162
 
2163
If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2164
use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2165
 
2166
@table @code
2167
@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2168
@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2169
Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2170
@code{vfork}.  A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2171
process.  The @var{mode} can be:
2172
 
2173
@table @code
2174
@item parent
2175
The original process is debugged after a fork.  The child process runs
2176
unimpeded.  This is the default.
2177
 
2178
@item child
2179
The new process is debugged after a fork.  The parent process runs
2180
unimpeded.
2181
 
2182
@item ask
2183
The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2184
@end table
2185
 
2186
@item show follow-fork-mode
2187
Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2188
@end table
2189
 
2190
If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2191
@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2192
breakpoint in the new target.  If you have a breakpoint set on
2193
@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2194
the child process's @code{main}.
2195
 
2196
When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2197
child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2198
 
2199
If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2200
call executes, the new target restarts.  To restart the parent process,
2201
use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2202
argument.
2203
 
2204
You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2205
a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made.  @xref{Set
2206
Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2207
 
2208
@node Stopping
2209
@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2210
 
2211
The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2212
program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2213
trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2214
 
2215
Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2216
such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2217
@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}.  You may then examine and
2218
change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2219
continue execution.  Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2220
ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2221
explicitly request this information at any time.
2222
 
2223
@table @code
2224
@kindex info program
2225
@item info program
2226
Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2227
running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2228
@end table
2229
 
2230
@menu
2231
* Breakpoints::                 Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2232
* Continuing and Stepping::     Resuming execution
2233
* Signals::                     Signals
2234
* Thread Stops::                Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2235
@end menu
2236
 
2237
@node Breakpoints
2238
@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2239
 
2240
@cindex breakpoints
2241
A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2242
the program is reached.  For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2243
control in finer detail whether your program stops.  You can set
2244
breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2245
Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2246
should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2247
program.
2248
 
2249
In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2250
breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run.  There is
2251
a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2252
is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2253
not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2254
arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2255
 
2256
@cindex watchpoints
2257
@cindex memory tracing
2258
@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2259
@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2260
A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2261
when the value of an expression changes.  You must use a different
2262
command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2263
watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2264
any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2265
and watchpoints using the same commands.
2266
 
2267
You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2268
whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint.  @xref{Auto Display,,
2269
Automatic display}.
2270
 
2271
@cindex catchpoints
2272
@cindex breakpoint on events
2273
A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2274
when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2275
exception or the loading of a library.  As with watchpoints, you use a
2276
different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2277
catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2278
other breakpoint.  (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2279
@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2280
 
2281
@cindex breakpoint numbers
2282
@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2283
@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2284
catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2285
starting with one.  In many of the commands for controlling various
2286
features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2287
breakpoint you want to change.  Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2288
@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2289
enable it again.
2290
 
2291
@cindex breakpoint ranges
2292
@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2293
Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2294
operate.  A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2295
@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2296
hyphen, like @samp{5-7}.  When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2297
all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2298
 
2299
@menu
2300
* Set Breaks::                  Setting breakpoints
2301
* Set Watchpoints::             Setting watchpoints
2302
* Set Catchpoints::             Setting catchpoints
2303
* Delete Breaks::               Deleting breakpoints
2304
* Disabling::                   Disabling breakpoints
2305
* Conditions::                  Break conditions
2306
* Break Commands::              Breakpoint command lists
2307
* Breakpoint Menus::            Breakpoint menus
2308
* Error in Breakpoints::        ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2309
@end menu
2310
 
2311
@node Set Breaks
2312
@subsection Setting breakpoints
2313
 
2314
@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2315
@c       consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2316
@c
2317
@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2318
 
2319
@kindex break
2320
@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2321
@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2322
@cindex latest breakpoint
2323
Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2324
@code{b}).  The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2325
number of the breakpoints you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2326
Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2327
convenience variables.
2328
 
2329
You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2330
 
2331
@table @code
2332
@item break @var{function}
2333
Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2334
When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2335
C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2336
@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2337
 
2338
@item break +@var{offset}
2339
@itemx break -@var{offset}
2340
Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2341
at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2342
(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2343
 
2344
@item break @var{linenum}
2345
Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2346
The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2347
The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2348
code on that line.
2349
 
2350
@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2351
Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2352
 
2353
@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2354
Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2355
@var{filename}.  Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2356
superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2357
functions.
2358
 
2359
@item break *@var{address}
2360
Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}.  You can use this to set
2361
breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2362
information or source files.
2363
 
2364
@item break
2365
When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2366
the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2367
(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}).  In any selected frame but the
2368
innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2369
returns to that frame.  This is similar to the effect of a
2370
@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2371
that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint.  If you use
2372
@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2373
the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2374
inside loops.
2375
 
2376
@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2377
least one instruction has been executed.  If it did not do this, you
2378
would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2379
breakpoint.  This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2380
existed when your program stopped.
2381
 
2382
@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2383
Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2384
@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2385
value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2386
@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2387
above (or no argument) specifying where to break.  @xref{Conditions,
2388
,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2389
 
2390
@kindex tbreak
2391
@item tbreak @var{args}
2392
Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop.  @var{args} are the
2393
same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2394
way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2395
program stops there.  @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2396
 
2397
@kindex hbreak
2398
@item hbreak @var{args}
2399
Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint.  @var{args} are the same as for the
2400
@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2401
breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2402
have this support.  The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2403
debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2404
changing the instruction.  This can be used with the new trap-generation
2405
provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets.  These targets
2406
will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2407
address that is assigned to the debug registers.  However the hardware
2408
breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints.  For
2409
example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2410
@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used.  Delete
2411
or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2412
(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}).  @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2413
 
2414
@kindex thbreak
2415
@item thbreak @var{args}
2416
Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop.  @var{args}
2417
are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2418
the same way.  However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2419
the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2420
first time your program stops there.  Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2421
command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2422
may not have this support.  @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2423
See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2424
 
2425
@kindex rbreak
2426
@cindex regular expression
2427
@item rbreak @var{regex}
2428
Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2429
@var{regex}.  This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2430
matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set.  Once these
2431
breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2432
the @code{break} command.  You can delete them, disable them, or make
2433
them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2434
 
2435
The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2436
like @file{grep}.  Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2437
shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2438
an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s.  There is an implicit
2439
@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2440
match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2441
 
2442
When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2443
breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2444
classes.
2445
 
2446
@kindex info breakpoints
2447
@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2448
@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2449
@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2450
@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2451
Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2452
not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2453
 
2454
@table @emph
2455
@item Breakpoint Numbers
2456
@item Type
2457
Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2458
@item Disposition
2459
Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2460
@item Enabled or Disabled
2461
Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}.  @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2462
that are not enabled.
2463
@item Address
2464
Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2465
@item What
2466
Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2467
line number.
2468
@end table
2469
 
2470
@noindent
2471
If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2472
the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2473
are listed after that.
2474
 
2475
@noindent
2476
@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2477
number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint.  The
2478
convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2479
the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2480
listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2481
 
2482
@noindent
2483
@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2484
has been hit.  This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2485
@code{ignore} command.  You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2486
hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2487
was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number.  This
2488
will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2489
@end table
2490
 
2491
@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2492
your program.  There is nothing silly or meaningless about this.  When
2493
the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2494
(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2495
 
2496
@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2497
@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2498
@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2499
purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2500
These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2501
@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2502
 
2503
You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2504
@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2505
 
2506
@table @code
2507
@kindex maint info breakpoints
2508
@item maint info breakpoints
2509
Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2510
breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2511
internal purposes.  Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2512
breakpoint numbers.  The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2513
is shown:
2514
 
2515
@table @code
2516
@item breakpoint
2517
Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2518
 
2519
@item watchpoint
2520
Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2521
 
2522
@item longjmp
2523
Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2524
@code{longjmp} calls.
2525
 
2526
@item longjmp resume
2527
Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2528
 
2529
@item until
2530
Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2531
 
2532
@item finish
2533
Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2534
 
2535
@item shlib events
2536
Shared library events.
2537
 
2538
@end table
2539
 
2540
@end table
2541
 
2542
 
2543
@node Set Watchpoints
2544
@subsection Setting watchpoints
2545
 
2546
@cindex setting watchpoints
2547
@cindex software watchpoints
2548
@cindex hardware watchpoints
2549
You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2550
expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2551
this may happen.
2552
 
2553
Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2554
hardware.  @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2555
program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2556
times slower than normal execution.  (But this may still be worth it, to
2557
catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2558
culprit.)
2559
 
2560
On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2561
@value{GDBN} includes support for
2562
hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2563
program.
2564
 
2565
@table @code
2566
@kindex watch
2567
@item watch @var{expr}
2568
Set a watchpoint for an expression.  @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2569
is written into by the program and its value changes.
2570
 
2571
@kindex rwatch
2572
@item rwatch @var{expr}
2573
Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2574
 
2575
@kindex awatch
2576
@item awatch @var{expr}
2577
Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2578
by the program.
2579
 
2580
@kindex info watchpoints
2581
@item info watchpoints
2582
This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2583
it is the same as @code{info break}.
2584
@end table
2585
 
2586
@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible.  Hardware
2587
watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2588
value at the exact instruction where the change occurs.  If @value{GDBN}
2589
cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2590
executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2591
statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2592
 
2593
When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2594
 
2595
@example
2596
Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2597
@end example
2598
 
2599
@noindent
2600
if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2601
 
2602
Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2603
hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2604
value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2605
every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2606
that currently.  If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2607
hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2608
will print a message like this:
2609
 
2610
@smallexample
2611
Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2612
@end smallexample
2613
 
2614
Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2615
data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2616
watchpoint on the target machine can handle.  For example, some systems
2617
can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2618
cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2619
double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2620
wide).  As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2621
into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2622
 
2623
If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2624
to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2625
Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2626
time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2627
able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2628
warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2629
 
2630
@smallexample
2631
Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2632
@end smallexample
2633
 
2634
@noindent
2635
If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2636
 
2637
The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2638
or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers.  For the
2639
data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command.  However the
2640
hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2641
both watchpoints must be the same kind.  For example, you can set two
2642
watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2643
@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2644
watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2645
@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2646
Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2647
 
2648
If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2649
any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2650
kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2651
 
2652
@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2653
(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2654
they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2655
which these variables were defined.  In particular, when the program
2656
being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2657
and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set.  If you
2658
rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again.  One
2659
way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2660
@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2661
 
2662
@quotation
2663
@cindex watchpoints and threads
2664
@cindex threads and watchpoints
2665
@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2666
usefulness.  With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2667
can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}.  If
2668
you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2669
thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2670
can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual.  However,
2671
@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2672
the expression.
2673
 
2674
@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2675
@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2676
have only limited usefulness.  If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2677
watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2678
single thread}.  If you are confident that the expression can only
2679
change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2680
confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2681
software watchpoints as usual.  However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2682
when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression.  (Hardware
2683
watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2684
@end quotation
2685
 
2686
@node Set Catchpoints
2687
@subsection Setting catchpoints
2688
@cindex catchpoints, setting
2689
@cindex exception handlers
2690
@cindex event handling
2691
 
2692
You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2693
kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2694
shared library.  Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2695
 
2696
@table @code
2697
@kindex catch
2698
@item catch @var{event}
2699
Stop when @var{event} occurs.  @var{event} can be any of the following:
2700
@table @code
2701
@item throw
2702
@kindex catch throw
2703
The throwing of a C++ exception.
2704
 
2705
@item catch
2706
@kindex catch catch
2707
The catching of a C++ exception.
2708
 
2709
@item exec
2710
@kindex catch exec
2711
A call to @code{exec}.  This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2712
 
2713
@item fork
2714
@kindex catch fork
2715
A call to @code{fork}.  This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2716
 
2717
@item vfork
2718
@kindex catch vfork
2719
A call to @code{vfork}.  This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2720
 
2721
@item load
2722
@itemx load @var{libname}
2723
@kindex catch load
2724
The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2725
@var{libname}.  This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2726
 
2727
@item unload
2728
@itemx unload @var{libname}
2729
@kindex catch unload
2730
The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2731
of the library @var{libname}.  This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2732
@end table
2733
 
2734
@item tcatch @var{event}
2735
Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop.  The catchpoint is
2736
automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2737
 
2738
@end table
2739
 
2740
Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2741
 
2742
There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2743
(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2744
 
2745
@itemize @bullet
2746
@item
2747
If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2748
control to you when the function has finished executing.  If the call
2749
raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2750
returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2751
simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2752
that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits.  This is the case even if
2753
you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2754
disabled within interactive calls.
2755
 
2756
@item
2757
You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2758
 
2759
@item
2760
You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2761
@end itemize
2762
 
2763
@cindex raise exceptions
2764
Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2765
if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2766
stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2767
can see the stack before any unwinding takes place.  If you set a
2768
breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2769
out where the exception was raised.
2770
 
2771
To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2772
knowledge of the implementation.  In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2773
raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2774
which has the following ANSI C interface:
2775
 
2776
@example
2777
    /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2778
       @var{id} is the exception identifier.  */
2779
    void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2780
@end example
2781
 
2782
@noindent
2783
To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2784
unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2785
(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2786
 
2787
With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2788
that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2789
a specific exception is raised.  You can use multiple conditional
2790
breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2791
raised.
2792
 
2793
 
2794
@node Delete Breaks
2795
@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2796
 
2797
@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2798
@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2799
It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2800
catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2801
to stop there.  This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint.  A
2802
breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2803
 
2804
With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2805
where they are in your program.  With the @code{delete} command you can
2806
delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2807
their breakpoint numbers.
2808
 
2809
It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it.  @value{GDBN}
2810
automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2811
when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2812
 
2813
@table @code
2814
@kindex clear
2815
@item clear
2816
Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2817
selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}).  When
2818
the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2819
breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2820
 
2821
@item clear @var{function}
2822
@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2823
Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2824
 
2825
@item clear @var{linenum}
2826
@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2827
Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2828
 
2829
@cindex delete breakpoints
2830
@kindex delete
2831
@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2832
@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2833
Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2834
ranges specified as arguments.  If no argument is specified, delete all
2835
breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2836
confirm off}).  You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2837
@end table
2838
 
2839
@node Disabling
2840
@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2841
 
2842
@kindex disable breakpoints
2843
@kindex enable breakpoints
2844
Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2845
prefer to @dfn{disable} it.  This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2846
it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2847
that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2848
 
2849
You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2850
the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2851
or more breakpoint numbers as arguments.  Use @code{info break} or
2852
@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2853
catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2854
 
2855
A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2856
states of enablement:
2857
 
2858
@itemize @bullet
2859
@item
2860
Enabled.  The breakpoint stops your program.  A breakpoint set
2861
with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2862
@item
2863
Disabled.  The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2864
@item
2865
Enabled once.  The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2866
disabled.
2867
@item
2868
Enabled for deletion.  The breakpoint stops your program, but
2869
immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently.  A breakpoint
2870
set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2871
@end itemize
2872
 
2873
You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2874
watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2875
 
2876
@table @code
2877
@kindex disable breakpoints
2878
@kindex disable
2879
@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2880
@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2881
Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2882
listed.  A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten.  All
2883
options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2884
case the breakpoint is enabled again later.  You may abbreviate
2885
@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2886
 
2887
@kindex enable breakpoints
2888
@kindex enable
2889
@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2890
Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints).  They
2891
become effective once again in stopping your program.
2892
 
2893
@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2894
Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily.  @value{GDBN} disables any
2895
of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2896
 
2897
@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
2898
Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die.  @value{GDBN}
2899
deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2900
@end table
2901
 
2902
@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2903
@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
2904
Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2905
,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2906
subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2907
the commands above.  (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2908
breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2909
breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2910
stepping}.)
2911
 
2912
@node Conditions
2913
@subsection Break conditions
2914
@cindex conditional breakpoints
2915
@cindex breakpoint conditions
2916
 
2917
@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr?  Context where wanted?
2918
@c      in particular for a watchpoint?
2919
The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2920
specified place.  You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2921
breakpoint.  A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2922
programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  A breakpoint with
2923
a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2924
and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2925
 
2926
This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2927
situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2928
when the condition is false.  In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2929
by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2930
@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2931
 
2932
Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2933
since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2934
it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2935
and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2936
one.
2937
 
2938
Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2939
your program.  This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2940
that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2941
format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2942
unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address.  (In
2943
that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2944
program without checking the condition of this one.)  Note that
2945
breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2946
conditions for the
2947
purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2948
(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2949
 
2950
Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2951
@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command.  @xref{Set
2952
Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.  They can also be changed at any time
2953
with the @code{condition} command.
2954
 
2955
You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2956
The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2957
@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2958
catchpoint.
2959
 
2960
@table @code
2961
@kindex condition
2962
@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2963
Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2964
watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}.  After you set a condition,
2965
breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2966
@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C).  When you use
2967
@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2968
syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
2969
referents in the context of your breakpoint.  If @var{expression} uses
2970
symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2971
prints an error message:
2972
 
2973
@example
2974
No symbol "foo" in current context.
2975
@end example
2976
 
2977
@noindent
2978
@value{GDBN} does
2979
not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
2980
command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2981
@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
2982
 
2983
@item condition @var{bnum}
2984
Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}.  It becomes
2985
an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2986
@end table
2987
 
2988
@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2989
A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2990
breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times.  This is so
2991
useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2992
count} of the breakpoint.  Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2993
is an integer.  Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2994
therefore has no effect.  But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2995
ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2996
the ignore count by one and continues.  As a result, if the ignore count
2997
value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
2998
your program reaches it.
2999
 
3000
@table @code
3001
@kindex ignore
3002
@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3003
Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3004
The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3005
execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3006
takes no action.
3007
 
3008
To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3009
a count of zero.
3010
 
3011
When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3012
breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3013
@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}.  @xref{Continuing and
3014
Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3015
 
3016
If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3017
condition is not checked.  Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3018
@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3019
 
3020
You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3021
as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3022
is decremented each time.  @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3023
variables}.
3024
@end table
3025
 
3026
Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3027
 
3028
 
3029
@node Break Commands
3030
@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3031
 
3032
@cindex breakpoint commands
3033
You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3034
commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint.  For
3035
example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3036
enable other breakpoints.
3037
 
3038
@table @code
3039
@kindex commands
3040
@kindex end
3041
@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3042
@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3043
@itemx end
3044
Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}.  The commands
3045
themselves appear on the following lines.  Type a line containing just
3046
@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3047
 
3048
To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3049
follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3050
 
3051
With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3052
breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3053
recently encountered).
3054
@end table
3055
 
3056
Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3057
disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3058
 
3059
You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again.  Simply
3060
use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3061
that resumes execution.
3062
 
3063
Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3064
execution, are ignored.  This is because any time you resume execution
3065
(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3066
another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3067
ambiguities about which list to execute.
3068
 
3069
@kindex silent
3070
If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3071
usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed.  This may
3072
be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3073
then continue.  If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3074
see no sign that the breakpoint was reached.  @code{silent} is
3075
meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3076
 
3077
The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3078
print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3079
breakpoints.  @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3080
 
3081
For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3082
value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3083
 
3084
@example
3085
break foo if x>0
3086
commands
3087
silent
3088
printf "x is %d\n",x
3089
cont
3090
end
3091
@end example
3092
 
3093
One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3094
you can test for another.  Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3095
of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3096
erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3097
to any variables that need them.  End with the @code{continue} command
3098
so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3099
command so that no output is produced.  Here is an example:
3100
 
3101
@example
3102
break 403
3103
commands
3104
silent
3105
set x = y + 4
3106
cont
3107
end
3108
@end example
3109
 
3110
@node Breakpoint Menus
3111
@subsection Breakpoint menus
3112
@cindex overloading
3113
@cindex symbol overloading
3114
 
3115
Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
3116
to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3117
This is called @dfn{overloading}.  When a function name is overloaded,
3118
@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3119
a breakpoint.  If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3120
something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3121
particular version of the function you want.  Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3122
you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3123
waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}.  The first two
3124
options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}.  Typing @kbd{1}
3125
sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3126
@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3127
breakpoints.
3128
 
3129
For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3130
breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3131
We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3132
 
3133
@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3134
@smallexample
3135
@group
3136
(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3137
[0] cancel
3138
[1] all
3139
[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3140
[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3141
[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3142
[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3143
[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3144
[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3145
> 2 4 6
3146
Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3147
Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3148
Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3149
Multiple breakpoints were set.
3150
Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3151
 breakpoints.
3152
(@value{GDBP})
3153
@end group
3154
@end smallexample
3155
 
3156
@c  @ifclear BARETARGET
3157
@node Error in Breakpoints
3158
@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3159
@c
3160
@c  FIXME!! 14/6/95  Is there a real example of this?  Let's use it.
3161
@c
3162
Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3163
any other process is running that program.  In this situation,
3164
attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3165
@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3166
 
3167
@example
3168
Cannot insert breakpoints.
3169
The same program may be running in another process.
3170
@end example
3171
 
3172
When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3173
 
3174
@enumerate
3175
@item
3176
Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3177
 
3178
@item
3179
Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3180
name.  Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3181
that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3182
Then start your program again.
3183
 
3184
@item
3185
Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3186
linker option @samp{-N}.  The operating system limitation may not apply
3187
to nonsharable executables.
3188
@end enumerate
3189
@c  @end ifclear
3190
 
3191
A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3192
hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3193
 
3194
@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3195
@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3196
@smallexample
3197
Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3198
You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3199
@end smallexample
3200
 
3201
@noindent
3202
This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3203
only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3204
watchpoints it needs to insert.
3205
 
3206
When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3207
hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3208
 
3209
 
3210
@node Continuing and Stepping
3211
@section Continuing and stepping
3212
 
3213
@cindex stepping
3214
@cindex continuing
3215
@cindex resuming execution
3216
@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3217
completes normally.  In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3218
one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3219
line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3220
particular command you use).  Either when continuing or when stepping,
3221
your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal.  (If
3222
it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3223
@samp{signal 0} to resume execution.  @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3224
 
3225
@table @code
3226
@kindex continue
3227
@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3228
@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3229
@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3230
@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3231
@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3232
Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3233
any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed.  The optional argument
3234
@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3235
ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3236
@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3237
 
3238
The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3239
stopped due to a breakpoint.  At other times, the argument to
3240
@code{continue} is ignored.
3241
 
3242
The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3243
debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3244
purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3245
@code{continue}.
3246
@end table
3247
 
3248
To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3249
(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3250
calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3251
different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3252
 
3253
A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3254
(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3255
beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3256
is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3257
and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3258
interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3259
 
3260
@table @code
3261
@kindex step
3262
@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3263
@item step
3264
Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3265
line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}.  This command is
3266
abbreviated @code{s}.
3267
 
3268
@quotation
3269
@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3270
@c numbers in the debugging information".  (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3271
@c not line numbers).  But it seems complex to try to make that
3272
@c distinction here.
3273
@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3274
within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3275
execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3276
debugging information.  Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3277
is compiled without debugging information.  To step through functions
3278
without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3279
below.
3280
@end quotation
3281
 
3282
The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3283
source line.  This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3284
switch statements, for loops, etc.  @code{step} continues to stop if a
3285
function that has debugging information is called within the line.
3286
In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions called
3287
within the line.
3288
 
3289
Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3290
number information for the function.  Otherwise it acts like the
3291
@code{next} command.  This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3292
on MIPS machines.  Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3293
was any debugging information about the routine.
3294
 
3295
@item step @var{count}
3296
Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times.  If a
3297
breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3298
@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3299
 
3300
@kindex next
3301
@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3302
@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3303
Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3304
This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3305
the line of code are executed without stopping.  Execution stops when
3306
control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3307
that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command.  This command
3308
is abbreviated @code{n}.
3309
 
3310
An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3311
 
3312
 
3313
@c  FIX ME!!  Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3314
@c  the following paragraph?   ---  Vctoria
3315
@c
3316
@c  @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3317
@c  @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3318
@c  function are executed without stopping.
3319
 
3320
The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3321
source line.  This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3322
switch statements, for loops, etc.
3323
 
3324
@kindex finish
3325
@item finish
3326
Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3327
returns.  Print the returned value (if any).
3328
 
3329
Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3330
,Returning from a function}).
3331
 
3332
@kindex until
3333
@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3334
@item until
3335
@itemx u
3336
Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3337
current stack frame, is reached.  This command is used to avoid single
3338
stepping through a loop more than once.  It is like the @code{next}
3339
command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3340
automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3341
than the address of the jump.
3342
 
3343
This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3344
though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3345
exits the loop.  In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3346
simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3347
through the next iteration.
3348
 
3349
@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3350
stack frame.
3351
 
3352
@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3353
of machine code does not match the order of the source lines.  For
3354
example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3355
(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3356
@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3357
 
3358
@example
3359
(@value{GDBP}) f
3360
#0  main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3361
206                 expand_input();
3362
(@value{GDBP}) until
3363
195             for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3364
@end example
3365
 
3366
This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3367
generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3368
start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3369
written before the body of the loop.  The @code{until} command appeared
3370
to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3371
expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3372
statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3373
 
3374
@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3375
instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3376
argument.
3377
 
3378
@item until @var{location}
3379
@itemx u @var{location}
3380
Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3381
reached, or the current stack frame returns.  @var{location} is any of
3382
the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3383
,Setting breakpoints}).  This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3384
and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3385
 
3386
@kindex stepi
3387
@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3388
@item stepi
3389
@itemx stepi @var{arg}
3390
@itemx si
3391
Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3392
 
3393
It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3394
instructions.  This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3395
instruction to be executed, each time your program stops.  @xref{Auto
3396
Display,, Automatic display}.
3397
 
3398
An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3399
 
3400
@need 750
3401
@kindex nexti
3402
@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3403
@item nexti
3404
@itemx nexti @var{arg}
3405
@itemx ni
3406
Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3407
proceed until the function returns.
3408
 
3409
An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3410
@end table
3411
 
3412
@node Signals
3413
@section Signals
3414
@cindex signals
3415
 
3416
A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program.  The
3417
operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3418
kind a name and a number.  For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3419
signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3420
@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3421
memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3422
the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3423
requested an alarm).
3424
 
3425
@cindex fatal signals
3426
Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3427
functioning of your program.  Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3428
errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3429
program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3430
@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3431
fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3432
 
3433
@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3434
program.  You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3435
signal.
3436
 
3437
@cindex handling signals
3438
Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3439
(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3440
but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3441
You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3442
 
3443
@table @code
3444
@kindex info signals
3445
@item info signals
3446
@itemx info handle
3447
Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3448
handle each one.  You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3449
the defined types of signals.
3450
 
3451
@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3452
 
3453
@kindex handle
3454
@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3455
Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}.  @var{signal} can
3456
be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3457
beginning).  The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3458
@end table
3459
 
3460
@c @group
3461
The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3462
Their full names are:
3463
 
3464
@table @code
3465
@item nostop
3466
@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens.  It may
3467
still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3468
 
3469
@item stop
3470
@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens.  This implies
3471
the @code{print} keyword as well.
3472
 
3473
@item print
3474
@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3475
 
3476
@item noprint
3477
@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all.  This
3478
implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3479
 
3480
@item pass
3481
@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3482
can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3483
and not handled.
3484
 
3485
@item nopass
3486
@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3487
@end table
3488
@c @end group
3489
 
3490
When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3491
program until you
3492
continue.  Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3493
effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}.  In other words,
3494
after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3495
command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3496
program sees that signal when you continue.
3497
 
3498
You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3499
seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3500
or to give it any signal at any time.  For example, if your program stopped
3501
due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3502
values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3503
execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3504
a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal.  To prevent this,
3505
you can continue with @samp{signal 0}.  @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3506
program a signal}.
3507
 
3508
@node Thread Stops
3509
@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3510
 
3511
When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3512
programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3513
breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3514
 
3515
@table @code
3516
@cindex breakpoints and threads
3517
@cindex thread breakpoints
3518
@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3519
@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3520
@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3521
@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3522
writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3523
 
3524
Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3525
to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3526
particular thread reaches this breakpoint.  @var{threadno} is one of the
3527
numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3528
column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3529
 
3530
If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3531
breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3532
program.
3533
 
3534
You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3535
well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3536
breakpoint condition, like this:
3537
 
3538
@smallexample
3539
(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3540
@end smallexample
3541
 
3542
@end table
3543
 
3544
@cindex stopped threads
3545
@cindex threads, stopped
3546
Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3547
@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread.  This
3548
allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3549
switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3550
underfoot.
3551
 
3552
@cindex continuing threads
3553
@cindex threads, continuing
3554
Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3555
executing.  @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3556
like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3557
 
3558
In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3559
Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3560
system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3561
execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3562
single step.  Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3563
statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3564
stops.
3565
 
3566
You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3567
continuing or even single-stepping.  This happens whenever some other
3568
thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3569
first thread completes whatever you requested.
3570
 
3571
On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3572
thread to run.
3573
 
3574
@table @code
3575
@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3576
Set the scheduler locking mode.  If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3577
locking and any thread may run at any time.  If @code{on}, then only the
3578
current thread may run when the inferior is resumed.  The @code{step}
3579
mode optimizes for single-stepping.  It stops other threads from
3580
``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3581
stepping.  Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3582
when you step.  They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3583
function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3584
like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}.  However, unless another
3585
thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3586
@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3587
 
3588
@item show scheduler-locking
3589
Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3590
@end table
3591
 
3592
 
3593
@node Stack
3594
@chapter Examining the Stack
3595
 
3596
When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3597
stopped and how it got there.
3598
 
3599
@cindex call stack
3600
Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3601
is generated.
3602
That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3603
the arguments of the call,
3604
and the local variables of the function being called.
3605
The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3606
The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3607
stack}.
3608
 
3609
When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3610
stack allow you to see all of this information.
3611
 
3612
@cindex selected frame
3613
One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3614
@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame.  In
3615
particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3616
your program, the value is found in the selected frame.  There are
3617
special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3618
interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3619
 
3620
When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3621
currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3622
@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3623
 
3624
@menu
3625
* Frames::                      Stack frames
3626
* Backtrace::                   Backtraces
3627
* Selection::                   Selecting a frame
3628
* Frame Info::                  Information on a frame
3629
 
3630
@end menu
3631
 
3632
@node Frames
3633
@section Stack frames
3634
 
3635
@cindex frame, definition
3636
@cindex stack frame
3637
The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3638
frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3639
with one call to one function.  The frame contains the arguments given
3640
to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3641
which the function is executing.
3642
 
3643
@cindex initial frame
3644
@cindex outermost frame
3645
@cindex innermost frame
3646
When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3647
function @code{main}.  This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3648
@dfn{outermost} frame.  Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3649
made.  Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3650
is eliminated.  If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3651
the same function.  The frame for the function in which execution is
3652
actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame.  This is the most
3653
recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3654
 
3655
@cindex frame pointer
3656
Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses.  A
3657
stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3658
kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3659
address serves as the address of the frame.  Usually this address is kept
3660
in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3661
going on in that frame.
3662
 
3663
@cindex frame number
3664
@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3665
zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3666
and so on upward.  These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3667
they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3668
frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3669
 
3670
@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3671
@c underflow problems.
3672
@cindex frameless execution
3673
Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3674
without stack frames.  (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3675
@example
3676
@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3677
@end example
3678
generates functions without a frame.)
3679
This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3680
the frame setup time.  @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3681
with these function invocations.  If the innermost function invocation
3682
has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3683
it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3684
correct tracing of the function call chain.  However, @value{GDBN} has
3685
no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3686
 
3687
@table @code
3688
@kindex frame@r{, command}
3689
@cindex current stack frame
3690
@item frame @var{args}
3691
The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3692
and to print the stack frame you select.  @var{args} may be either the
3693
address of the frame or the stack frame number.  Without an argument,
3694
@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3695
 
3696
@kindex select-frame
3697
@cindex selecting frame silently
3698
@item select-frame
3699
The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3700
to another without printing the frame.  This is the silent version of
3701
@code{frame}.
3702
@end table
3703
 
3704
@node Backtrace
3705
@section Backtraces
3706
 
3707
@cindex backtraces
3708
@cindex tracebacks
3709
@cindex stack traces
3710
A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is.  It shows one
3711
line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3712
frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3713
stack.
3714
 
3715
@table @code
3716
@kindex backtrace
3717
@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3718
@item backtrace
3719
@itemx bt
3720
Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3721
frames in the stack.
3722
 
3723
You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3724
character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3725
 
3726
@item backtrace @var{n}
3727
@itemx bt @var{n}
3728
Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3729
 
3730
@item backtrace -@var{n}
3731
@itemx bt -@var{n}
3732
Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3733
@end table
3734
 
3735
@kindex where
3736
@kindex info stack
3737
@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3738
The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3739
are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3740
 
3741
Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3742
The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3743
print address off}.  The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3744
line number, as well as the arguments to the function.  The program
3745
counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3746
line number.
3747
 
3748
Here is an example of a backtrace.  It was made with the command
3749
@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3750
 
3751
@smallexample
3752
@group
3753
#0  m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3754
    at builtin.c:993
3755
#1  0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3756
#2  0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3757
    at macro.c:71
3758
(More stack frames follow...)
3759
@end group
3760
@end smallexample
3761
 
3762
@noindent
3763
The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3764
value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3765
code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3766
 
3767
@node Selection
3768
@section Selecting a frame
3769
 
3770
Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3771
whichever stack frame is selected at the moment.  Here are the commands for
3772
selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3773
of the stack frame just selected.
3774
 
3775
@table @code
3776
@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3777
@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3778
@item frame @var{n}
3779
@itemx f @var{n}
3780
Select frame number @var{n}.  Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3781
(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3782
innermost one, and so on.  The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3783
@code{main}.
3784
 
3785
@item frame @var{addr}
3786
@itemx f @var{addr}
3787
Select the frame at address @var{addr}.  This is useful mainly if the
3788
chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3789
impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames.  In
3790
addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3791
switches between them.
3792
 
3793
On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3794
select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3795
 
3796
On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3797
pointer and a program counter.
3798
 
3799
On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3800
pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3801
@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3802
@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files.  The above is up to date
3803
@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3804
 
3805
@kindex up
3806
@item up @var{n}
3807
Move @var{n} frames up the stack.  For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3808
advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3809
that have existed longer.  @var{n} defaults to one.
3810
 
3811
@kindex down
3812
@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3813
@item down @var{n}
3814
Move @var{n} frames down the stack.  For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3815
advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3816
that were created more recently.  @var{n} defaults to one.  You may
3817
abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3818
@end table
3819
 
3820
All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3821
frame.  The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3822
arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3823
frame.  The second line shows the text of that source line.
3824
 
3825
@need 1000
3826
For example:
3827
 
3828
@smallexample
3829
@group
3830
(@value{GDBP}) up
3831
#1  0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3832
    at env.c:10
3833
10              read_input_file (argv[i]);
3834
@end group
3835
@end smallexample
3836
 
3837
After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3838
prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3839
@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3840
 
3841
@table @code
3842
@kindex down-silently
3843
@kindex up-silently
3844
@item up-silently @var{n}
3845
@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3846
These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3847
respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3848
causing display of the new frame.  They are intended primarily for use
3849
in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3850
distracting.
3851
@end table
3852
 
3853
@node Frame Info
3854
@section Information about a frame
3855
 
3856
There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3857
stack frame.
3858
 
3859
@table @code
3860
@item frame
3861
@itemx f
3862
When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3863
frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3864
selected stack frame.  It can be abbreviated @code{f}.  With an
3865
argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3866
@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3867
 
3868
@kindex info frame
3869
@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
3870
@item info frame
3871
@itemx info f
3872
This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3873
including:
3874
 
3875
@itemize @bullet
3876
@item
3877
the address of the frame
3878
@item
3879
the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3880
@item
3881
the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3882
@item
3883
the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3884
@item
3885
the address of the frame's arguments
3886
@item
3887
the address of the frame's local variables
3888
@item
3889
the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3890
@item
3891
which registers were saved in the frame
3892
@end itemize
3893
 
3894
@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3895
something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3896
the usual conventions.
3897
 
3898
@item info frame @var{addr}
3899
@itemx info f @var{addr}
3900
Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3901
selecting that frame.  The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3902
command.  This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3903
architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3904
@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3905
 
3906
@kindex info args
3907
@item info args
3908
Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3909
 
3910
@item info locals
3911
@kindex info locals
3912
Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3913
line.  These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3914
accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3915
 
3916
@kindex info catch
3917
@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3918
@cindex exception handlers, how to list
3919
@item info catch
3920
Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3921
current stack frame at the current point of execution.  To see other
3922
exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3923
@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3924
@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
3925
 
3926
@end table
3927
 
3928
 
3929
@node Source
3930
@chapter Examining Source Files
3931
 
3932
@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3933
information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3934
used to build it.  When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3935
the line where it stopped.  Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3936
(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3937
execution in that frame has stopped.  You can print other portions of
3938
source files by explicit command.
3939
 
3940
If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
3941
prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
3942
@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
3943
 
3944
@menu
3945
* List::                        Printing source lines
3946
* Search::                      Searching source files
3947
* Source Path::                 Specifying source directories
3948
* Machine Code::                Source and machine code
3949
@end menu
3950
 
3951
@node List
3952
@section Printing source lines
3953
 
3954
@kindex list
3955
@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
3956
To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3957
(abbreviated @code{l}).  By default, ten lines are printed.
3958
There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3959
 
3960
Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3961
 
3962
@table @code
3963
@item list @var{linenum}
3964
Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3965
current source file.
3966
 
3967
@item list @var{function}
3968
Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3969
@var{function}.
3970
 
3971
@item list
3972
Print more lines.  If the last lines printed were printed with a
3973
@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3974
printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3975
as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3976
Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3977
 
3978
@item list -
3979
Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3980
@end table
3981
 
3982
By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
3983
the @code{list} command.  You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
3984
 
3985
@table @code
3986
@kindex set listsize
3987
@item set listsize @var{count}
3988
Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
3989
the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
3990
 
3991
@kindex show listsize
3992
@item show listsize
3993
Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
3994
@end table
3995
 
3996
Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
3997
so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}.  This is more useful
3998
than listing the same lines again.  An exception is made for an
3999
argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4000
each repetition moves up in the source file.
4001
 
4002
@cindex linespec
4003
In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4004
@dfn{linespecs}.  Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4005
of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4006
Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4007
 
4008
@table @code
4009
@item list @var{linespec}
4010
Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4011
 
4012
@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4013
Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}.  Both arguments are
4014
linespecs.
4015
 
4016
@item list ,@var{last}
4017
Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4018
 
4019
@item list @var{first},
4020
Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4021
 
4022
@item list +
4023
Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4024
 
4025
@item list -
4026
Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4027
 
4028
@item list
4029
As described in the preceding table.
4030
@end table
4031
 
4032
Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4033
kinds of linespec.
4034
 
4035
@table @code
4036
@item @var{number}
4037
Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4038
When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4039
the same source file as the first linespec.
4040
 
4041
@item +@var{offset}
4042
Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4043
When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4044
two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4045
first linespec.
4046
 
4047
@item -@var{offset}
4048
Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4049
 
4050
@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4051
Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4052
 
4053
@item @var{function}
4054
Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4055
For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4056
 
4057
@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4058
Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4059
function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}.  You only need the
4060
file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4061
identically named functions in different source files.
4062
 
4063
@item *@var{address}
4064
Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4065
@var{address} may be any expression.
4066
@end table
4067
 
4068
@node Search
4069
@section Searching source files
4070
@cindex searching
4071
@kindex reverse-search
4072
 
4073
There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4074
regular expression.
4075
 
4076
@table @code
4077
@kindex search
4078
@kindex forward-search
4079
@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4080
@itemx search @var{regexp}
4081
The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4082
starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4083
@var{regexp}.  It lists the line that is found.  You can use the
4084
synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4085
@code{fo}.
4086
 
4087
@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4088
The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4089
with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4090
for @var{regexp}.  It lists the line that is found.  You can abbreviate
4091
this command as @code{rev}.
4092
@end table
4093
 
4094
@node Source Path
4095
@section Specifying source directories
4096
 
4097
@cindex source path
4098
@cindex directories for source files
4099
Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4100
files from which they were compiled, just the names.  Even when they do,
4101
the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4102
session.  @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4103
this is called the @dfn{source path}.  Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4104
it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4105
in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.  Note that
4106
the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose.  Neither is
4107
the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4108
path.
4109
 
4110
If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4111
object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4112
too.  If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4113
compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4114
last resort.
4115
 
4116
Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4117
any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4118
each line is in the file.
4119
 
4120
@kindex directory
4121
@kindex dir
4122
When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4123
and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4124
To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4125
 
4126
@table @code
4127
@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4128
@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4129
Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path.  Several
4130
directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4131
(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4132
part of absolute file names) or
4133
whitespace.  You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4134
path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4135
 
4136
@kindex cdir
4137
@kindex cwd
4138
@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4139
@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4140
@cindex compilation directory
4141
@cindex current directory
4142
@cindex working directory
4143
@cindex directory, current
4144
@cindex directory, compilation
4145
You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4146
directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4147
working directory.  @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4148
tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4149
session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4150
directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4151
 
4152
@item directory
4153
Reset the source path to empty again.  This requires confirmation.
4154
 
4155
@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4156
@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that.  (thanks to RMS)
4157
 
4158
@item show directories
4159
@kindex show directories
4160
Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4161
@end table
4162
 
4163
If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4164
interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4165
versions of source.  You can correct the situation as follows:
4166
 
4167
@enumerate
4168
@item
4169
Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4170
 
4171
@item
4172
Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4173
directories you want in the source path.  You can add all the
4174
directories in one command.
4175
@end enumerate
4176
 
4177
@node Machine Code
4178
@section Source and machine code
4179
 
4180
You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4181
addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4182
a range of addresses as machine instructions.  When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4183
mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4184
line specified.  Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4185
well as hex.
4186
 
4187
@table @code
4188
@kindex info line
4189
@item info line @var{linespec}
4190
Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4191
source line @var{linespec}.  You can specify source lines in any of
4192
the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4193
source lines}).
4194
@end table
4195
 
4196
For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4197
the object code for the first line of function
4198
@code{m4_changequote}:
4199
 
4200
@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4201
@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4202
@smallexample
4203
(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4204
Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4205
@end smallexample
4206
 
4207
@noindent
4208
We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4209
@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4210
@smallexample
4211
(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4212
Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4213
@end smallexample
4214
 
4215
@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4216
@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4217
After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4218
is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4219
sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4220
,Examining memory}).  Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4221
convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4222
variables}).
4223
 
4224
@table @code
4225
@kindex disassemble
4226
@cindex assembly instructions
4227
@cindex instructions, assembly
4228
@cindex machine instructions
4229
@cindex listing machine instructions
4230
@item disassemble
4231
This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4232
instructions.  The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4233
program counter of the selected frame.  A single argument to this
4234
command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4235
surrounding this value.  Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4236
(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4237
@end table
4238
 
4239
The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4240
HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4241
 
4242
@smallexample
4243
(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4244
Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4245
0x32c4 <main+204>:      addil 0,dp
4246
0x32c8 <main+208>:      ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4247
0x32cc <main+212>:      ldil 0x3000,r31
4248
0x32d0 <main+216>:      ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4249
0x32d4 <main+220>:      ldo 0(r31),rp
4250
0x32d8 <main+224>:      addil -0x800,dp
4251
0x32dc <main+228>:      ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4252
0x32e0 <main+232>:      ldil 0x3000,r31
4253
End of assembler dump.
4254
@end smallexample
4255
 
4256
Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4257
mnemonics or other syntax.
4258
 
4259
@table @code
4260
@kindex set disassembly-flavor
4261
@cindex assembly instructions
4262
@cindex instructions, assembly
4263
@cindex machine instructions
4264
@cindex listing machine instructions
4265
@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4266
@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4267
@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4268
Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4269
program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4270
 
4271
Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family.  You
4272
can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4273
The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4274
assemblers for x86-based targets.
4275
@end table
4276
 
4277
 
4278
@node Data
4279
@chapter Examining Data
4280
 
4281
@cindex printing data
4282
@cindex examining data
4283
@kindex print
4284
@kindex inspect
4285
@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4286
@c document because it is nonstandard...  Under Epoch it displays in a
4287
@c different window or something like that.
4288
The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4289
command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}.  It
4290
evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4291
program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4292
Different Languages}).
4293
 
4294
@table @code
4295
@item print @var{expr}
4296
@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4297
@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language).  By default the
4298
value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4299
you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4300
@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4301
formats}.
4302
 
4303
@item print
4304
@itemx print /@var{f}
4305
If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4306
@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}).  This allows you to
4307
conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4308
@end table
4309
 
4310
A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4311
It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4312
specified format.  @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4313
 
4314
If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4315
fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4316
command rather than @code{print}.  @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4317
Table}.
4318
 
4319
@menu
4320
* Expressions::                 Expressions
4321
* Variables::                   Program variables
4322
* Arrays::                      Artificial arrays
4323
* Output Formats::              Output formats
4324
* Memory::                      Examining memory
4325
* Auto Display::                Automatic display
4326
* Print Settings::              Print settings
4327
* Value History::               Value history
4328
* Convenience Vars::            Convenience variables
4329
* Registers::                   Registers
4330
* Floating Point Hardware::     Floating point hardware
4331
@end menu
4332
 
4333
@node Expressions
4334
@section Expressions
4335
 
4336
@cindex expressions
4337
@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4338
compute its value.  Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4339
by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4340
@value{GDBN}.  This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4341
and string constants.  It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4342
by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4343
 
4344
@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4345
the user.  The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}.  For example,
4346
you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4347
memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4348
 
4349
Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4350
this manual are in C.  @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4351
Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4352
languages.
4353
 
4354
In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4355
expressions regardless of your programming language.
4356
 
4357
Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4358
useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4359
at that address in memory.
4360
@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4361
 
4362
@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4363
to programming languages:
4364
 
4365
@table @code
4366
@item @@
4367
@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4368
@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4369
 
4370
@item ::
4371
@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4372
function where it is defined.  @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4373
 
4374
@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4375
@cindex type casting memory
4376
@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4377
@cindex casts, to view memory
4378
@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4379
Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4380
memory.  @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4381
pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4382
a cast).  This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4383
normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4384
@end table
4385
 
4386
@node Variables
4387
@section Program variables
4388
 
4389
The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4390
in your program.
4391
 
4392
Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4393
(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4394
 
4395
@itemize @bullet
4396
@item
4397
global (or file-static)
4398
@end itemize
4399
 
4400
@noindent or
4401
 
4402
@itemize @bullet
4403
@item
4404
visible according to the scope rules of the
4405
programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4406
@end itemize
4407
 
4408
@noindent This means that in the function
4409
 
4410
@example
4411
foo (a)
4412
     int a;
4413
@{
4414
  bar (a);
4415
  @{
4416
    int b = test ();
4417
    bar (b);
4418
  @}
4419
@}
4420
@end example
4421
 
4422
@noindent
4423
you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4424
executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4425
examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4426
the block where @code{b} is declared.
4427
 
4428
@cindex variable name conflict
4429
There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4430
scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4431
in this file.  But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4432
function with the same name (in different source files).  If that
4433
happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects.  If you wish,
4434
you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4435
using the colon-colon notation:
4436
 
4437
@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4438
@iftex
4439
@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4440
@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4441
@end iftex
4442
@example
4443
@var{file}::@var{variable}
4444
@var{function}::@var{variable}
4445
@end example
4446
 
4447
@noindent
4448
Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4449
static @var{variable}.  In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4450
make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4451
to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4452
 
4453
@example
4454
(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4455
@end example
4456
 
4457
@cindex C++ scope resolution
4458
This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4459
use of the same notation in C++.  @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4460
scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4461
@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4462
@c conflict??  --mew
4463
 
4464
@cindex wrong values
4465
@cindex variable values, wrong
4466
@quotation
4467
@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4468
wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4469
scope, and just before exit.
4470
@end quotation
4471
You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4472
This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4473
set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4474
stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4475
values until the stack frame is completely built.  On exit, it usually
4476
also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4477
after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4478
variable definitions may be gone.
4479
 
4480
This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4481
To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4482
when compiling.
4483
 
4484
@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4485
Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4486
unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4487
opposed to memory addresses).  Depending on the support for such cases
4488
offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4489
might not be able to display values for such local variables.  If that
4490
happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4491
 
4492
@example
4493
No symbol "foo" in current context.
4494
@end example
4495
 
4496
To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4497
different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4498
formats.  For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4499
supports the @samp{-gstabs} option.  @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4500
in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF.  You may be able
4501
to use DWARF-2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4502
debug info.  See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4503
Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4504
information.
4505
 
4506
 
4507
@node Arrays
4508
@section Artificial arrays
4509
 
4510
@cindex artificial array
4511
@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4512
It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4513
same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4514
dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4515
program.
4516
 
4517
You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4518
@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}.  The left
4519
operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4520
and be an individual object.  The right operand should be the desired length
4521
of the array.  The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4522
the type of the left argument.  The first element is actually the left
4523
argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4524
following those that hold the first element, and so on.  Here is an
4525
example.  If a program says
4526
 
4527
@example
4528
int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4529
@end example
4530
 
4531
@noindent
4532
you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4533
 
4534
@example
4535
p *array@@len
4536
@end example
4537
 
4538
The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory.  Array values made
4539
with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4540
subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4541
Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4542
(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4543
 
4544
Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4545
This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4546
The value need not be in memory:
4547
@example
4548
(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4549
$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4550
@end example
4551
 
4552
As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4553
@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4554
the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4555
@example
4556
(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4557
$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4558
@end example
4559
 
4560
Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4561
moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4562
actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4563
of pointers in an array.  One useful work-around in this situation is
4564
to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4565
variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4566
interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}.  For
4567
instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4568
structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4569
in each structure.  Here is an example of what you might type:
4570
 
4571
@example
4572
set $i = 0
4573
p dtab[$i++]->fv
4574
@key{RET}
4575
@key{RET}
4576
@dots{}
4577
@end example
4578
 
4579
@node Output Formats
4580
@section Output formats
4581
 
4582
@cindex formatted output
4583
@cindex output formats
4584
By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type.  Sometimes
4585
this is not what you want.  For example, you might want to print a number
4586
in hex, or a pointer in decimal.  Or you might want to view data in memory
4587
at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction.  To do
4588
these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4589
 
4590
The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4591
already computed.  This is done by starting the arguments of the
4592
@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter.  The format
4593
letters supported are:
4594
 
4595
@table @code
4596
@item x
4597
Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4598
hexadecimal.
4599
 
4600
@item d
4601
Print as integer in signed decimal.
4602
 
4603
@item u
4604
Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4605
 
4606
@item o
4607
Print as integer in octal.
4608
 
4609
@item t
4610
Print as integer in binary.  The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4611
@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4612
used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4613
see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4614
 
4615
@item a
4616
@cindex unknown address, locating
4617
Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4618
the nearest preceding symbol.  You can use this format used to discover
4619
where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4620
 
4621
@example
4622
(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4623
$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4624
@end example
4625
 
4626
@item c
4627
Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4628
 
4629
@item f
4630
Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4631
using typical floating point syntax.
4632
@end table
4633
 
4634
For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4635
 
4636
@example
4637
p/x $pc
4638
@end example
4639
 
4640
@noindent
4641
Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4642
names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4643
 
4644
To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4645
you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4646
expression.  For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4647
 
4648
@node Memory
4649
@section Examining memory
4650
 
4651
You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4652
any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4653
 
4654
@cindex examining memory
4655
@table @code
4656
@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4657
@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4658
@itemx x @var{addr}
4659
@itemx x
4660
Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4661
@end table
4662
 
4663
@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4664
much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4665
expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4666
If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4667
Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4668
 
4669
@table @r
4670
@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4671
The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1.  It specifies
4672
how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4673
@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4674
@c 4.1.2.
4675
 
4676
@item @var{f}, the display format
4677
The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4678
@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4679
The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4680
The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4681
 
4682
@item @var{u}, the unit size
4683
The unit size is any of
4684
 
4685
@table @code
4686
@item b
4687
Bytes.
4688
@item h
4689
Halfwords (two bytes).
4690
@item w
4691
Words (four bytes).  This is the initial default.
4692
@item g
4693
Giant words (eight bytes).
4694
@end table
4695
 
4696
Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4697
default unit the next time you use @code{x}.  (For the @samp{s} and
4698
@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4699
 
4700
@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4701
@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4702
memory.  The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4703
it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4704
@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions.  The default for
4705
@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4706
other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4707
the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4708
starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4709
a value from memory).
4710
@end table
4711
 
4712
For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4713
(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4714
starting at address @code{0x54320}.  @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4715
words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4716
@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4717
 
4718
Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4719
letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4720
unit size or format comes first; either order works.  The output
4721
specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4722
(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4723
 
4724
Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4725
and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4726
@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4727
including any operands.  The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4728
alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4729
Code,,Source and machine code}.
4730
 
4731
All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4732
easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4733
you use @code{x}.  For example, after you have inspected three machine
4734
instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4735
with just @samp{x/7}.  If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4736
the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4737
for successive uses of @code{x}.
4738
 
4739
@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4740
The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4741
in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4742
would get in the way.  Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4743
subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4744
@code{$_} and @code{$__}.  After an @code{x} command, the last address
4745
examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4746
@code{$_}.  The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4747
the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4748
 
4749
If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4750
are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4751
address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4752
 
4753
@node Auto Display
4754
@section Automatic display
4755
@cindex automatic display
4756
@cindex display of expressions
4757
 
4758
If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4759
(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4760
display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4761
Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4762
to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4763
The automatic display looks like this:
4764
 
4765
@example
4766
2: foo = 38
4767
3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4768
@end example
4769
 
4770
@noindent
4771
This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values.  As with
4772
displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4773
specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4774
whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4775
format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4776
or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4777
supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4778
 
4779
@table @code
4780
@kindex display
4781
@item display @var{expr}
4782
Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
4783
each time your program stops.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4784
 
4785
@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4786
 
4787
@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
4788
For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
4789
count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
4790
arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4791
@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4792
 
4793
@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4794
For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4795
number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4796
be examined each time your program stops.  Examining means in effect
4797
doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}.  @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4798
@end table
4799
 
4800
For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4801
instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
4802
is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
4803
 
4804
@table @code
4805
@kindex delete display
4806
@kindex undisplay
4807
@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4808
@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4809
Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4810
 
4811
@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4812
(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4813
 
4814
@kindex disable display
4815
@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4816
Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}.  A disabled display
4817
item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten.  It may be
4818
enabled again later.
4819
 
4820
@kindex enable display
4821
@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4822
Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}.  It becomes effective once
4823
again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4824
 
4825
@item display
4826
Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4827
done when your program stops.
4828
 
4829
@kindex info display
4830
@item info display
4831
Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4832
automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4833
values.  This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4834
It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4835
because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4836
@end table
4837
 
4838
If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4839
sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up.  Such an
4840
expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4841
variables is not defined.  For example, if you give the command
4842
@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4843
@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4844
continues to stop inside that function.  When it stops elsewhere---where
4845
there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4846
automatically.  The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4847
is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4848
 
4849
@node Print Settings
4850
@section Print settings
4851
 
4852
@cindex format options
4853
@cindex print settings
4854
@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4855
and symbols are printed.
4856
 
4857
@noindent
4858
These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4859
 
4860
@table @code
4861
@kindex set print address
4862
@item set print address
4863
@itemx set print address on
4864
@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4865
traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4866
even when it also displays the contents of those addresses.  The default
4867
is @code{on}.  For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4868
@code{set print address on}:
4869
 
4870
@smallexample
4871
@group
4872
(@value{GDBP}) f
4873
#0  set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4874
    at input.c:530
4875
530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
4876
@end group
4877
@end smallexample
4878
 
4879
@item set print address off
4880
Do not print addresses when displaying their contents.  For example,
4881
this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4882
 
4883
@smallexample
4884
@group
4885
(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4886
(@value{GDBP}) f
4887
#0  set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4888
530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
4889
@end group
4890
@end smallexample
4891
 
4892
You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4893
dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface.  For example, with
4894
@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4895
all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4896
 
4897
@kindex show print address
4898
@item show print address
4899
Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4900
@end table
4901
 
4902
When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4903
closest earlier symbol plus an offset.  If that symbol does not uniquely
4904
identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4905
source file), you may need to clarify.  One way to do this is with
4906
@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}.  Alternately,
4907
you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4908
it prints a symbolic address:
4909
 
4910
@table @code
4911
@kindex set print symbol-filename
4912
@item set print symbol-filename on
4913
Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4914
symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4915
 
4916
@item set print symbol-filename off
4917
Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol.  This is the
4918
default.
4919
 
4920
@kindex show print symbol-filename
4921
@item show print symbol-filename
4922
Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4923
line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4924
@end table
4925
 
4926
Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4927
numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4928
number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4929
 
4930
Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4931
printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4932
 
4933
@table @code
4934
@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4935
@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4936
Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4937
offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4938
@var{max-offset}.  The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4939
to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4940
 
4941
@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4942
@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4943
Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4944
symbolic address.
4945
@end table
4946
 
4947
@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4948
@cindex pointer, finding referent
4949
If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4950
@samp{set print symbol-filename on}.  Then you can determine the name
4951
and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4952
@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}.  This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4953
For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4954
at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4955
 
4956
@example
4957
(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4958
(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4959
$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4960
@end example
4961
 
4962
@quotation
4963
@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4964
does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4965
the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4966
@end quotation
4967
 
4968
Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4969
 
4970
@table @code
4971
@kindex set print array
4972
@item set print array
4973
@itemx set print array on
4974
Pretty print arrays.  This format is more convenient to read,
4975
but uses more space.  The default is off.
4976
 
4977
@item set print array off
4978
Return to compressed format for arrays.
4979
 
4980
@kindex show print array
4981
@item show print array
4982
Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
4983
arrays.
4984
 
4985
@kindex set print elements
4986
@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
4987
Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
4988
If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
4989
printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
4990
This limit also applies to the display of strings.
4991
When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
4992
Setting  @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
4993
 
4994
@kindex show print elements
4995
@item show print elements
4996
Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
4997
If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
4998
 
4999
@kindex set print null-stop
5000
@item set print null-stop
5001
Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5002
@sc{null} is encountered.  This is useful when large arrays actually
5003
contain only short strings.
5004
The default is off.
5005
 
5006
@kindex set print pretty
5007
@item set print pretty on
5008
Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5009
per line, like this:
5010
 
5011
@smallexample
5012
@group
5013
$1 = @{
5014
  next = 0x0,
5015
  flags = @{
5016
    sweet = 1,
5017
    sour = 1
5018
  @},
5019
  meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5020
@}
5021
@end group
5022
@end smallexample
5023
 
5024
@item set print pretty off
5025
Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5026
 
5027
@smallexample
5028
@group
5029
$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5030
meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5031
@end group
5032
@end smallexample
5033
 
5034
@noindent
5035
This is the default format.
5036
 
5037
@kindex show print pretty
5038
@item show print pretty
5039
Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5040
 
5041
@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5042
@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5043
Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5044
@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5045
character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}.  This setting is
5046
best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5047
high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5048
 
5049
@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5050
Print full eight-bit characters.  This allows the use of more
5051
international character sets, and is the default.
5052
 
5053
@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5054
@item show print sevenbit-strings
5055
Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5056
 
5057
@kindex set print union
5058
@item set print union on
5059
Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures.  This
5060
is the default setting.
5061
 
5062
@item set print union off
5063
Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5064
 
5065
@kindex show print union
5066
@item show print union
5067
Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5068
structures.
5069
 
5070
For example, given the declarations
5071
 
5072
@smallexample
5073
typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5074
typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5075
typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5076
              Bug_forms;
5077
 
5078
struct thing @{
5079
  Species it;
5080
  union @{
5081
    Tree_forms tree;
5082
    Bug_forms bug;
5083
  @} form;
5084
@};
5085
 
5086
struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5087
@end smallexample
5088
 
5089
@noindent
5090
with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5091
 
5092
@smallexample
5093
$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5094
@end smallexample
5095
 
5096
@noindent
5097
and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5098
 
5099
@smallexample
5100
$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5101
@end smallexample
5102
@end table
5103
 
5104
@need 1000
5105
@noindent
5106
These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
5107
 
5108
@table @code
5109
@cindex demangling
5110
@kindex set print demangle
5111
@item set print demangle
5112
@itemx set print demangle on
5113
Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5114
(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5115
linkage.  The default is on.
5116
 
5117
@kindex show print demangle
5118
@item show print demangle
5119
Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5120
 
5121
@kindex set print asm-demangle
5122
@item set print asm-demangle
5123
@itemx set print asm-demangle on
5124
Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5125
in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5126
The default is off.
5127
 
5128
@kindex show print asm-demangle
5129
@item show print asm-demangle
5130
Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5131
or demangled form.
5132
 
5133
@kindex set demangle-style
5134
@cindex C++ symbol decoding style
5135
@cindex symbol decoding style, C++
5136
@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5137
Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5138
represent C++ names.  The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5139
 
5140
@table @code
5141
@item auto
5142
Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5143
 
5144
@item gnu
5145
Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5146
This is the default.
5147
 
5148
@item hp
5149
Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5150
 
5151
@item lucid
5152
Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5153
 
5154
@item arm
5155
Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
5156
@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5157
debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables.  @value{GDBN} would
5158
require further enhancement to permit that.
5159
 
5160
@end table
5161
If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5162
 
5163
@kindex show demangle-style
5164
@item show demangle-style
5165
Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
5166
 
5167
@kindex set print object
5168
@item set print object
5169
@itemx set print object on
5170
When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5171
(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5172
the virtual function table.
5173
 
5174
@item set print object off
5175
Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5176
virtual function table.  This is the default setting.
5177
 
5178
@kindex show print object
5179
@item show print object
5180
Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5181
 
5182
@kindex set print static-members
5183
@item set print static-members
5184
@itemx set print static-members on
5185
Print static members when displaying a C++ object.  The default is on.
5186
 
5187
@item set print static-members off
5188
Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
5189
 
5190
@kindex show print static-members
5191
@item show print static-members
5192
Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
5193
 
5194
@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5195
@kindex set print vtbl
5196
@item set print vtbl
5197
@itemx set print vtbl on
5198
Pretty print C++ virtual function tables.  The default is off.
5199
(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5200
ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5201
 
5202
@item set print vtbl off
5203
Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
5204
 
5205
@kindex show print vtbl
5206
@item show print vtbl
5207
Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5208
@end table
5209
 
5210
@node Value History
5211
@section Value history
5212
 
5213
@cindex value history
5214
Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5215
@dfn{value history}.  This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5216
Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5217
(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5218
When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5219
since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5220
symbol table.
5221
 
5222
@cindex @code{$}
5223
@cindex @code{$$}
5224
@cindex history number
5225
The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5226
refer to them.  These are successive integers starting with one.
5227
@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5228
printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5229
history number.
5230
 
5231
To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5232
history number.  The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5233
remind you of this.  Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5234
the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5235
@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5236
is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5237
@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5238
 
5239
For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5240
want to see the contents of the structure.  It suffices to type
5241
 
5242
@example
5243
p *$
5244
@end example
5245
 
5246
If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5247
to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5248
 
5249
@example
5250
p *$.next
5251
@end example
5252
 
5253
@noindent
5254
You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5255
command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5256
 
5257
Note that the history records values, not expressions.  If the value of
5258
@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5259
 
5260
@example
5261
print x
5262
set x=5
5263
@end example
5264
 
5265
@noindent
5266
then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5267
remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5268
 
5269
@table @code
5270
@kindex show values
5271
@item show values
5272
Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5273
This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5274
values} does not change the history.
5275
 
5276
@item show values @var{n}
5277
Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5278
 
5279
@item show values +
5280
Print ten history values just after the values last printed.  If no more
5281
values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5282
@end table
5283
 
5284
Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5285
same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5286
 
5287
@node Convenience Vars
5288
@section Convenience variables
5289
 
5290
@cindex convenience variables
5291
@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5292
@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later.  These variables
5293
exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5294
setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5295
of your program.  That is why you can use them freely.
5296
 
5297
Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}.  Any name preceded by
5298
@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5299
the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5300
(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5301
by @samp{$}.  @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5302
 
5303
You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5304
expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5305
For example:
5306
 
5307
@example
5308
set $foo = *object_ptr
5309
@end example
5310
 
5311
@noindent
5312
would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5313
@code{object_ptr}.
5314
 
5315
Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5316
value is @code{void} until you assign a new value.  You can alter the
5317
value with another assignment at any time.
5318
 
5319
Convenience variables have no fixed types.  You can assign a convenience
5320
variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5321
that variable already has a value of a different type.  The convenience
5322
variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5323
 
5324
@table @code
5325
@kindex show convenience
5326
@item show convenience
5327
Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5328
Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5329
@end table
5330
 
5331
One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5332
incremented or a pointer to be advanced.  For example, to print
5333
a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5334
 
5335
@example
5336
set $i = 0
5337
print bar[$i++]->contents
5338
@end example
5339
 
5340
@noindent
5341
Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5342
 
5343
Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5344
values likely to be useful.
5345
 
5346
@table @code
5347
@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5348
@item $_
5349
The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5350
the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).  Other
5351
commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5352
set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5353
and @code{info breakpoint}.  The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5354
except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5355
to the type of @code{$__}.
5356
 
5357
@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5358
@item $__
5359
The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5360
to the value found in the last address examined.  Its type is chosen
5361
to match the format in which the data was printed.
5362
 
5363
@item $_exitcode
5364
@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5365
The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5366
the program being debugged terminates.
5367
@end table
5368
 
5369
On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5370
begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5371
name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5372
 
5373
@node Registers
5374
@section Registers
5375
 
5376
@cindex registers
5377
You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5378
with names starting with @samp{$}.  The names of registers are different
5379
for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5380
your machine.
5381
 
5382
@table @code
5383
@kindex info registers
5384
@item info registers
5385
Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5386
registers (in the selected stack frame).
5387
 
5388
@kindex info all-registers
5389
@cindex floating point registers
5390
@item info all-registers
5391
Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5392
registers.
5393
 
5394
@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5395
Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5396
As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5397
the selected stack frame.  @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5398
the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5399
@end table
5400
 
5401
@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5402
expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5403
architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers.  The register names
5404
@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5405
the stack pointer.  @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5406
pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5407
register that contains the processor status.  For example,
5408
you could print the program counter in hex with
5409
 
5410
@example
5411
p/x $pc
5412
@end example
5413
 
5414
@noindent
5415
or print the instruction to be executed next with
5416
 
5417
@example
5418
x/i $pc
5419
@end example
5420
 
5421
@noindent
5422
or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5423
one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5424
memory (most machines, nowadays).  This assumes that the innermost
5425
stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5426
stack frames are selected.  To pop entire frames off the stack,
5427
regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5428
see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5429
 
5430
@example
5431
set $sp += 4
5432
@end example
5433
 
5434
Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5435
your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5436
so long as there is no conflict.  The @code{info registers} command
5437
shows the canonical names.  For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5438
registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5439
can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5440
is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5441
 
5442
@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5443
integer when the register is examined in this way.  Some machines have
5444
special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5445
registers are considered to have floating point values.  There is no way
5446
to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5447
(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5448
@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5449
 
5450
Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats.  This
5451
means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5452
the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5453
sees.  For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5454
coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5455
programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format.  In such
5456
cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5457
that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5458
prints the data in both formats.
5459
 
5460
Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5461
(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}).  This means that you get the
5462
value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5463
were exited and their saved registers restored.  In order to see the
5464
true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5465
frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5466
 
5467
However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5468
code generated by your compiler.  If some registers are not saved, or if
5469
@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5470
frame makes no difference.
5471
 
5472
@node Floating Point Hardware
5473
@section Floating point hardware
5474
@cindex floating point
5475
 
5476
Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5477
you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5478
 
5479
@table @code
5480
@kindex info float
5481
@item info float
5482
Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5483
point unit.  The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5484
floating point chip.  Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5485
the ARM and x86 machines.
5486
@end table
5487
 
5488
@node Languages
5489
@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5490
@cindex languages
5491
 
5492
Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5493
rarely expressed in the same manner.  For instance, in ANSI C,
5494
dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5495
Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}.  Values can also be
5496
represented (and displayed) differently.  Hex numbers in C appear as
5497
@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
5498
 
5499
@cindex working language
5500
Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5501
allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5502
native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5503
consistent with the syntax of your program's native language.  The
5504
language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5505
language}.
5506
 
5507
@menu
5508
* Setting::                     Switching between source languages
5509
* Show::                        Displaying the language
5510
* Checks::                      Type and range checks
5511
* Support::                     Supported languages
5512
@end menu
5513
 
5514
@node Setting
5515
@section Switching between source languages
5516
 
5517
There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5518
set it automatically, or select it manually yourself.  You can use the
5519
@code{set language} command for either purpose.  On startup, @value{GDBN}
5520
defaults to setting the language automatically.  The working language is
5521
used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5522
are printed, etc.
5523
 
5524
In addition to the working language, every source file that
5525
@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language.  For some object
5526
file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5527
source file is in.  However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5528
language from the name of the file.  The language of a source file
5529
controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5530
show each frame appropriately for its own language.  There is no way to
5531
set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5532
set the language associated with a filename extension.  @xref{Show, ,
5533
Displaying the language}.
5534
 
5535
This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5536
as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
5537
another language.  In that case, make the
5538
program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5539
@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5540
program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5541
 
5542
@menu
5543
* Filenames::                   Filename extensions and languages.
5544
* Manually::                    Setting the working language manually
5545
* Automatically::               Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5546
@end menu
5547
 
5548
@node Filenames
5549
@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5550
 
5551
If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5552
@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5553
 
5554
@table @file
5555
 
5556
@item .c
5557
C source file
5558
 
5559
@item .C
5560
@itemx .cc
5561
@itemx .cp
5562
@itemx .cpp
5563
@itemx .cxx
5564
@itemx .c++
5565
C++ source file
5566
 
5567
@item .f
5568
@itemx .F
5569
Fortran source file
5570
 
5571
@item .ch
5572
@itemx .c186
5573
@itemx .c286
5574
CHILL source file
5575
 
5576
@item .mod
5577
Modula-2 source file
5578
 
5579
@item .s
5580
@itemx .S
5581
Assembler source file.  This actually behaves almost like C, but
5582
@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5583
@end table
5584
 
5585
In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5586
extension.  @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5587
 
5588
@node Manually
5589
@subsection Setting the working language
5590
 
5591
If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5592
expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5593
your program.
5594
 
5595
@kindex set language
5596
If you wish, you may set the language manually.  To do this, issue the
5597
command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5598
a language, such as
5599
@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
5600
For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5601
 
5602
Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5603
language automatically.  This can lead to confusion if you try
5604
to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5605
source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5606
languages---but means different things.  For instance, if the current
5607
source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5608
command such as:
5609
 
5610
@example
5611
print a = b + c
5612
@end example
5613
 
5614
@noindent
5615
might not have the effect you intended.  In C, this means to add
5616
@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}.  The result
5617
printed would be the value of @code{a}.  In Modula-2, this means to compare
5618
@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
5619
 
5620
@node Automatically
5621
@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5622
 
5623
To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5624
@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}.  @value{GDBN}
5625
then infers the working language.  That is, when your program stops in a
5626
frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5627
working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5628
frame.  If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5629
or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5630
does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5631
not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5632
 
5633
This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5634
entirely in one source language.  However, program modules and libraries
5635
written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5636
a different source language.  Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5637
case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5638
 
5639
@node Show
5640
@section Displaying the language
5641
 
5642
The following commands help you find out which language is the
5643
working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5644
 
5645
@kindex show language
5646
@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5647
@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
5648
@table @code
5649
@item show language
5650
Display the current working language.  This is the
5651
language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5652
build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5653
 
5654
@item info frame
5655
Display the source language for this frame.  This language becomes the
5656
working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5657
@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
5658
information listed here.
5659
 
5660
@item info source
5661
Display the source language of this source file.
5662
@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
5663
information listed here.
5664
@end table
5665
 
5666
In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5667
not in the standard list.  You can then set the extension associated
5668
with a language explicitly:
5669
 
5670
@kindex set extension-language
5671
@kindex info extensions
5672
@table @code
5673
@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5674
Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5675
the source language @var{language}.
5676
 
5677
@item info extensions
5678
List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5679
@end table
5680
 
5681
@node Checks
5682
@section Type and range checking
5683
 
5684
@quotation
5685
@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5686
checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect.  This
5687
section documents the intended facilities.
5688
@end quotation
5689
@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5690
 
5691
Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5692
errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks.  These include
5693
checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5694
sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time.  Checks such as
5695
these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5696
by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5697
errors when your program is running.
5698
 
5699
@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5700
Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5701
can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5702
the @code{print} command, for example.  As with the working language,
5703
@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5704
your program's source language.  @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5705
for the default settings of supported languages.
5706
 
5707
@menu
5708
* Type Checking::               An overview of type checking
5709
* Range Checking::              An overview of range checking
5710
@end menu
5711
 
5712
@cindex type checking
5713
@cindex checks, type
5714
@node Type Checking
5715
@subsection An overview of type checking
5716
 
5717
Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5718
arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5719
otherwise an error occurs.  These checks prevent type mismatch
5720
errors from ever causing any run-time problems.  For example,
5721
 
5722
@smallexample
5723
1 + 2 @result{} 3
5724
@exdent but
5725
@error{} 1 + 2.3
5726
@end smallexample
5727
 
5728
The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5729
type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5730
 
5731
For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5732
@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5733
to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5734
or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
5735
but evaluate the expression anyway.  When you choose the last of
5736
these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5737
also issues a warning.
5738
 
5739
Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5740
related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5741
For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5742
a @code{struct foo}.  These particular type errors have nothing to do
5743
with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
5744
the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5745
 
5746
Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type.  For
5747
instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5748
operators to be numbers.  In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5749
represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5750
operators.  @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5751
details on specific languages.
5752
 
5753
@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5754
 
5755
@kindex set check@r{, type}
5756
@kindex set check type
5757
@kindex show check type
5758
@table @code
5759
@item set check type auto
5760
Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5761
@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5762
each language.
5763
 
5764
@item set check type on
5765
@itemx set check type off
5766
Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5767
current working language.  Issue a warning if the setting does not
5768
match the language default.  If any type mismatches occur in
5769
evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
5770
message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5771
 
5772
@item set check type warn
5773
Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5774
evaluate the expression.  Evaluating the expression may still
5775
be impossible for other reasons.  For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5776
numbers and structures.
5777
 
5778
@item show type
5779
Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
5780
is setting it automatically.
5781
@end table
5782
 
5783
@cindex range checking
5784
@cindex checks, range
5785
@node Range Checking
5786
@subsection An overview of range checking
5787
 
5788
In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5789
bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks.  Such range
5790
checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5791
computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5792
not exceed the bounds of the array.
5793
 
5794
For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5795
@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5796
always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5797
warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5798
 
5799
A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5800
array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5801
of any type.  Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5802
error.  In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5803
result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5804
the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5805
 
5806
@example
5807
@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5808
@end example
5809
 
5810
This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5811
specific to individual compilers or machines.  @xref{Support, ,
5812
Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5813
 
5814
@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5815
 
5816
@kindex set check@r{, range}
5817
@kindex set check range
5818
@kindex show check range
5819
@table @code
5820
@item set check range auto
5821
Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5822
@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5823
each language.
5824
 
5825
@item set check range on
5826
@itemx set check range off
5827
Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5828
current working language.  A warning is issued if the setting does not
5829
match the language default.  If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
5830
then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
5831
 
5832
@item set check range warn
5833
Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5834
but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway.  Evaluating the
5835
expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5836
memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5837
systems).
5838
 
5839
@item show range
5840
Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5841
being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5842
@end table
5843
 
5844
@node Support
5845
@section Supported languages
5846
 
5847
@value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5848
@c This is false ...
5849
Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
5850
language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
5851
and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
5852
,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
5853
language.
5854
 
5855
The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
5856
supported by @value{GDBN}.  These sections are not meant to be language
5857
tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
5858
@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
5859
formats should look like for different languages.  There are many good
5860
books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
5861
language reference or tutorial.
5862
 
5863
@menu
5864
* C::           C and C++
5865
* Modula-2::    Modula-2
5866
* Chill::        Chill
5867
@end menu
5868
 
5869
@node C
5870
@subsection C and C++
5871
 
5872
@cindex C and C++
5873
@cindex expressions in C or C++
5874
 
5875
Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
5876
to both languages.  Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
5877
together.
5878
 
5879
@cindex C@t{++}
5880
@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
5881
@cindex @sc{gnu} C++
5882
The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
5883
compiler and @value{GDBN}.  Therefore, to debug your C++ code
5884
effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
5885
C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
5886
compiler (@code{aCC}).
5887
 
5888
For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
5889
format.  You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
5890
command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}.  See
5891
@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
5892
CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
5893
 
5894
@menu
5895
* C Operators::                 C and C++ operators
5896
* C Constants::                 C and C++ constants
5897
* C plus plus expressions::     C++ expressions
5898
* C Defaults::                  Default settings for C and C++
5899
* C Checks::                    C and C++ type and range checks
5900
* Debugging C::                 @value{GDBN} and C
5901
* Debugging C plus plus::       @value{GDBN} features for C++
5902
@end menu
5903
 
5904
@node C Operators
5905
@subsubsection C and C++ operators
5906
 
5907
@cindex C and C++ operators
5908
 
5909
Operators must be defined on values of specific types.  For instance,
5910
@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures.  Operators are
5911
often defined on groups of types.
5912
 
5913
For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
5914
 
5915
@itemize @bullet
5916
 
5917
@item
5918
@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
5919
specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
5920
 
5921
@item
5922
@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
5923
@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
5924
 
5925
@item
5926
@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
5927
 
5928
@item
5929
@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
5930
 
5931
@end itemize
5932
 
5933
@noindent
5934
The following operators are supported.  They are listed here
5935
in order of increasing precedence:
5936
 
5937
@table @code
5938
@item ,
5939
The comma or sequencing operator.  Expressions in a comma-separated list
5940
are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
5941
expression being the last expression evaluated.
5942
 
5943
@item =
5944
Assignment.  The value of an assignment expression is the value
5945
assigned.  Defined on scalar types.
5946
 
5947
@item @var{op}=
5948
Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
5949
and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
5950
@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
5951
@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
5952
@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
5953
 
5954
@item ?:
5955
The ternary operator.  @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
5956
of as:  if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}.  @var{a} should be of an
5957
integral type.
5958
 
5959
@item ||
5960
Logical @sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
5961
 
5962
@item &&
5963
Logical @sc{and}.  Defined on integral types.
5964
 
5965
@item |
5966
Bitwise @sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
5967
 
5968
@item ^
5969
Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
5970
 
5971
@item &
5972
Bitwise @sc{and}.  Defined on integral types.
5973
 
5974
@item ==@r{, }!=
5975
Equality and inequality.  Defined on scalar types.  The value of these
5976
expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
5977
 
5978
@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
5979
Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
5980
Defined on scalar types.  The value of these expressions is 0 for false
5981
and non-zero for true.
5982
 
5983
@item <<@r{, }>>
5984
left shift, and right shift.  Defined on integral types.
5985
 
5986
@item @@
5987
The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
5988
 
5989
@item +@r{, }-
5990
Addition and subtraction.  Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
5991
pointer types.
5992
 
5993
@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
5994
Multiplication, division, and modulus.  Multiplication and division are
5995
defined on integral and floating-point types.  Modulus is defined on
5996
integral types.
5997
 
5998
@item ++@r{, }--
5999
Increment and decrement.  When appearing before a variable, the
6000
operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6001
when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6002
operation takes place.
6003
 
6004
@item *
6005
Pointer dereferencing.  Defined on pointer types.  Same precedence as
6006
@code{++}.
6007
 
6008
@item &
6009
Address operator.  Defined on variables.  Same precedence as @code{++}.
6010
 
6011
For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6012
allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
6013
(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
6014
where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
6015
stored.
6016
 
6017
@item -
6018
Negative.  Defined on integral and floating-point types.  Same
6019
precedence as @code{++}.
6020
 
6021
@item !
6022
Logical negation.  Defined on integral types.  Same precedence as
6023
@code{++}.
6024
 
6025
@item ~
6026
Bitwise complement operator.  Defined on integral types.  Same precedence as
6027
@code{++}.
6028
 
6029
 
6030
@item .@r{, }->
6031
Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member.  For convenience,
6032
@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6033
pointer based on the stored type information.
6034
Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6035
 
6036
@item .*@r{, }->*
6037
Dereferences of pointers to members.
6038
 
6039
@item []
6040
Array indexing.  @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6041
@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}.  Same precedence as @code{->}.
6042
 
6043
@item ()
6044
Function parameter list.  Same precedence as @code{->}.
6045
 
6046
@item ::
6047
C++ scope resolution operator.  Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
6048
and @code{class} types.
6049
 
6050
@item ::
6051
Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6052
(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  Same precedence as @code{::},
6053
above.
6054
@end table
6055
 
6056
If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6057
attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6058
predefined meaning.
6059
 
6060
@menu
6061
* C Constants::
6062
@end menu
6063
 
6064
@node C Constants
6065
@subsubsection C and C++ constants
6066
 
6067
@cindex C and C++ constants
6068
 
6069
@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
6070
following ways:
6071
 
6072
@itemize @bullet
6073
@item
6074
Integer constants are a sequence of digits.  Octal constants are
6075
specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6076
a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}.  Constants may also end with a letter
6077
@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6078
@code{long} value.
6079
 
6080
@item
6081
Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6082
point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6083
exponent.  An exponent is of the form:
6084
@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6085
sequence of digits.  The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
6086
A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6087
@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6088
the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6089
a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6090
constant.
6091
 
6092
@item
6093
Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6094
integral equivalents.
6095
 
6096
@item
6097
Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6098
(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
6099
(usually its @sc{ascii} value).  Within quotes, the single character may
6100
be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6101
the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6102
of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6103
@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6104
@samp{\n} for newline.
6105
 
6106
@item
6107
String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6108
double quotes (@code{"}).  Any valid character constant (as described
6109
above) may appear.  Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6110
a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6111
characters.
6112
 
6113
@item
6114
Pointer constants are an integral value.  You can also write pointers
6115
to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6116
 
6117
@item
6118
Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6119
and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6120
integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6121
and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6122
@end itemize
6123
 
6124
@menu
6125
* C plus plus expressions::
6126
* C Defaults::
6127
* C Checks::
6128
 
6129
* Debugging C::
6130
@end menu
6131
 
6132
@node C plus plus expressions
6133
@subsubsection C++ expressions
6134
 
6135
@cindex expressions in C++
6136
@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
6137
 
6138
@cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
6139
@cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
6140
@cindex C++ and object formats
6141
@cindex object formats and C++
6142
@cindex a.out and C++
6143
@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
6144
@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
6145
@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
6146
@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
6147
@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6148
@c periodically whether this has happened...
6149
@quotation
6150
@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
6151
proper compiler.  Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
6152
additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6153
special support.  In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6154
@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6155
symbol table, these facilities are all available.  (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6156
you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6157
extensions explicitly.)  Where the object code format is standard
6158
@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
6159
support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6160
@end quotation
6161
 
6162
@enumerate
6163
 
6164
@cindex member functions
6165
@item
6166
Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6167
 
6168
@example
6169
count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6170
@end example
6171
 
6172
@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
6173
@cindex namespace in C++
6174
@item
6175
While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6176
expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6177
that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
6178
pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
6179
 
6180
@cindex call overloaded functions
6181
@cindex overloaded functions, calling
6182
@cindex type conversions in C++
6183
@item
6184
You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
6185
call to the right definition, with some restrictions.  @value{GDBN} does not
6186
perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6187
calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6188
in the program.  It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6189
default arguments.
6190
 
6191
It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6192
promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6193
class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6194
functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6195
number of function arguments.
6196
 
6197
Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6198
@code{set overload-resolution off}.  @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
6199
,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
6200
 
6201
You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
6202
explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6203
@smallexample
6204
p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6205
@end smallexample
6206
 
6207
The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
6208
see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
6209
 
6210
@cindex reference declarations
6211
@item
6212
@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
6213
them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6214
dereferenced.
6215
 
6216
In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6217
reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6218
avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6219
The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6220
you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6221
 
6222
@item
6223
@value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6224
expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do.  Since
6225
one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6226
necessary, for example in an expression like
6227
@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}.  @value{GDBN} also allows
6228
resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6229
debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6230
@end enumerate
6231
 
6232
In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6233
calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6234
objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6235
invoking user-defined operators.
6236
 
6237
@node C Defaults
6238
@subsubsection C and C++ defaults
6239
 
6240
@cindex C and C++ defaults
6241
 
6242
If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6243
both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6244
C or C++.  This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6245
selects the working language.
6246
 
6247
If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6248
recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6249
@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6250
these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6251
@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6252
for further details.
6253
 
6254
@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6255
@c unimplemented.  If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6256
@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
6257
 
6258
@node C Checks
6259
@subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
6260
 
6261
@cindex C and C++ checks
6262
 
6263
By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6264
is not used.  However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6265
considers two variables type equivalent if:
6266
 
6267
@itemize @bullet
6268
@item
6269
The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6270
enumerated tag.
6271
 
6272
@item
6273
The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6274
declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6275
 
6276
@ignore
6277
@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6278
@c FIXME--beers?
6279
@item
6280
The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6281
declared in the same declaration.  (Note: this may not be true for all C
6282
compilers.)
6283
@end ignore
6284
@end itemize
6285
 
6286
Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations.  Array
6287
indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6288
that is not itself an array.
6289
 
6290
@node Debugging C
6291
@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
6292
 
6293
The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6294
the @code{union} type.  When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
6295
inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed.  Otherwise, it
6296
appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
6297
 
6298
The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6299
with pointers and a memory allocation function.  @xref{Expressions,
6300
,Expressions}.
6301
 
6302
@menu
6303
* Debugging C plus plus::
6304
@end menu
6305
 
6306
@node Debugging C plus plus
6307
@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
6308
 
6309
@cindex commands for C++
6310
 
6311
Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6312
designed specifically for use with C++.  Here is a summary:
6313
 
6314
@table @code
6315
@cindex break in overloaded functions
6316
@item @r{breakpoint menus}
6317
When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6318
@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6319
you want.  @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6320
 
6321
@cindex overloading in C++
6322
@item rbreak @var{regex}
6323
Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6324
breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6325
classes.
6326
@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6327
 
6328
@cindex C++ exception handling
6329
@item catch throw
6330
@itemx catch catch
6331
Debug C++ exception handling using these commands.  @xref{Set
6332
Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6333
 
6334
@cindex inheritance
6335
@item ptype @var{typename}
6336
Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6337
@var{typename}.
6338
@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6339
 
6340
@cindex C++ symbol display
6341
@item set print demangle
6342
@itemx show print demangle
6343
@itemx set print asm-demangle
6344
@itemx show print asm-demangle
6345
Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6346
displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6347
@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6348
 
6349
@item set print object
6350
@itemx show print object
6351
Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6352
@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6353
 
6354
@item set print vtbl
6355
@itemx show print vtbl
6356
Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6357
@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6358
(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6359
ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6360
 
6361
@kindex set overload-resolution
6362
@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
6363
@item set overload-resolution on
6364
Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation.  The default
6365
is on.  For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6366
and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
6367
using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6368
expressions}, for details).  If it cannot find a match, it emits a
6369
message.
6370
 
6371
@item set overload-resolution off
6372
Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation.  For
6373
overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6374
chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6375
symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type.  For
6376
overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6377
searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6378
argument types.
6379
 
6380
@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6381
You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6382
the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6383
@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}.  You can
6384
also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6385
available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6386
@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6387
@end table
6388
 
6389
@node Modula-2
6390
@subsection Modula-2
6391
 
6392
@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
6393
 
6394
The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6395
output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6396
developed).  Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6397
attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6398
to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6399
table.
6400
 
6401
@cindex expressions in Modula-2
6402
@menu
6403
* M2 Operators::                Built-in operators
6404
* Built-In Func/Proc::          Built-in functions and procedures
6405
* M2 Constants::                Modula-2 constants
6406
* M2 Defaults::                 Default settings for Modula-2
6407
* Deviations::                  Deviations from standard Modula-2
6408
* M2 Checks::                   Modula-2 type and range checks
6409
* M2 Scope::                    The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6410
* GDB/M2::                      @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6411
@end menu
6412
 
6413
@node M2 Operators
6414
@subsubsection Operators
6415
@cindex Modula-2 operators
6416
 
6417
Operators must be defined on values of specific types.  For instance,
6418
@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures.  Operators are
6419
often defined on groups of types.  For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6420
following definitions hold:
6421
 
6422
@itemize @bullet
6423
 
6424
@item
6425
@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6426
their subranges.
6427
 
6428
@item
6429
@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6430
 
6431
@item
6432
@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6433
 
6434
@item
6435
@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6436
@var{type}}.
6437
 
6438
@item
6439
@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6440
 
6441
@item
6442
@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6443
 
6444
@item
6445
@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6446
@end itemize
6447
 
6448
@noindent
6449
The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6450
increasing precedence:
6451
 
6452
@table @code
6453
@item ,
6454
Function argument or array index separator.
6455
 
6456
@item :=
6457
Assignment.  The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6458
@var{value}.
6459
 
6460
@item <@r{, }>
6461
Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6462
types.
6463
 
6464
@item <=@r{, }>=
6465
Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
6466
on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6467
set types.  Same precedence as @code{<}.
6468
 
6469
@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6470
Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6471
Same precedence as @code{<}.  In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6472
available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6473
comment character.
6474
 
6475
@item IN
6476
Set membership.  Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6477
Same precedence as @code{<}.
6478
 
6479
@item OR
6480
Boolean disjunction.  Defined on boolean types.
6481
 
6482
@item AND@r{, }&
6483
Boolean conjunction.  Defined on boolean types.
6484
 
6485
@item @@
6486
The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6487
 
6488
@item +@r{, }-
6489
Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6490
and difference on set types.
6491
 
6492
@item *
6493
Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6494
on set types.
6495
 
6496
@item /
6497
Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6498
types.  Same precedence as @code{*}.
6499
 
6500
@item DIV@r{, }MOD
6501
Integer division and remainder.  Defined on integral types.  Same
6502
precedence as @code{*}.
6503
 
6504
@item -
6505
Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6506
 
6507
@item ^
6508
Pointer dereferencing.  Defined on pointer types.
6509
 
6510
@item NOT
6511
Boolean negation.  Defined on boolean types.  Same precedence as
6512
@code{^}.
6513
 
6514
@item .
6515
@code{RECORD} field selector.  Defined on @code{RECORD} data.  Same
6516
precedence as @code{^}.
6517
 
6518
@item []
6519
Array indexing.  Defined on @code{ARRAY} data.  Same precedence as @code{^}.
6520
 
6521
@item ()
6522
Procedure argument list.  Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects.  Same precedence
6523
as @code{^}.
6524
 
6525
@item ::@r{, }.
6526
@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6527
@end table
6528
 
6529
@quotation
6530
@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6531
treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6532
@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6533
@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6534
@end quotation
6535
 
6536
@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6537
@node Built-In Func/Proc
6538
@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6539
 
6540
Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6541
In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6542
 
6543
@table @var
6544
 
6545
@item a
6546
represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6547
 
6548
@item c
6549
represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6550
 
6551
@item i
6552
represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6553
 
6554
@item m
6555
represents an identifier that belongs to a set.  Generally used in the
6556
same function with the metavariable @var{s}.  The type of @var{s} should
6557
be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6558
 
6559
@item n
6560
represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6561
 
6562
@item r
6563
represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6564
 
6565
@item t
6566
represents a type.
6567
 
6568
@item v
6569
represents a variable.
6570
 
6571
@item x
6572
represents a variable or constant of one of many types.  See the
6573
explanation of the function for details.
6574
@end table
6575
 
6576
All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6577
 
6578
@table @code
6579
@item ABS(@var{n})
6580
Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6581
 
6582
@item CAP(@var{c})
6583
If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
6584
equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
6585
 
6586
@item CHR(@var{i})
6587
Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6588
 
6589
@item DEC(@var{v})
6590
Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one.  Returns the new value.
6591
 
6592
@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6593
Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}.  Returns the
6594
new value.
6595
 
6596
@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6597
Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}.  Returns the new
6598
set.
6599
 
6600
@item FLOAT(@var{i})
6601
Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6602
 
6603
@item HIGH(@var{a})
6604
Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6605
 
6606
@item INC(@var{v})
6607
Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one.  Returns the new value.
6608
 
6609
@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6610
Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}.  Returns the
6611
new value.
6612
 
6613
@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6614
Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6615
there.  Returns the new set.
6616
 
6617
@item MAX(@var{t})
6618
Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6619
 
6620
@item MIN(@var{t})
6621
Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6622
 
6623
@item ODD(@var{i})
6624
Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6625
 
6626
@item ORD(@var{x})
6627
Returns the ordinal value of its argument.  For example, the ordinal
6628
value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
6629
@sc{ascii} character set).  @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
6630
integral, character and enumerated types.
6631
 
6632
@item SIZE(@var{x})
6633
Returns the size of its argument.  @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6634
 
6635
@item TRUNC(@var{r})
6636
Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6637
 
6638
@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6639
Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6640
@end table
6641
 
6642
@quotation
6643
@emph{Warning:}  Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6644
@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6645
an error.
6646
@end quotation
6647
 
6648
@cindex Modula-2 constants
6649
@node M2 Constants
6650
@subsubsection Constants
6651
 
6652
@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6653
ways:
6654
 
6655
@itemize @bullet
6656
 
6657
@item
6658
Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits.  When used in an
6659
expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6660
rest of the expression.  Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6661
trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6662
 
6663
@item
6664
Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6665
decimal point and another sequence of digits.  An optional exponent can
6666
then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6667
@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent.  All of the
6668
digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6669
digits.
6670
 
6671
@item
6672
Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6673
like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).  They may
6674
also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
6675
followed by a @samp{C}.
6676
 
6677
@item
6678
String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6679
pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6680
Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed.  @xref{C
6681
Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6682
sequences.
6683
 
6684
@item
6685
Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6686
 
6687
@item
6688
Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6689
@code{FALSE}.
6690
 
6691
@item
6692
Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6693
 
6694
@item
6695
Set constants are not yet supported.
6696
@end itemize
6697
 
6698
@node M2 Defaults
6699
@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6700
@cindex Modula-2 defaults
6701
 
6702
If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6703
both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
6704
Modula-2.  This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6705
selected the working language.
6706
 
6707
If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6708
code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
6709
working language to Modula-2.  @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
6710
the language automatically}, for further details.
6711
 
6712
@node Deviations
6713
@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6714
@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6715
 
6716
A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6717
This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6718
 
6719
@itemize @bullet
6720
@item
6721
Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6722
integers.  This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6723
debugging.  (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6724
pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6725
through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6726
returned a pointer.)
6727
 
6728
@item
6729
C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6730
non-printable characters.  @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6731
escape sequences embedded.  Single non-printable characters are
6732
printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6733
 
6734
@item
6735
The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6736
argument.
6737
 
6738
@item
6739
All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6740
@end itemize
6741
 
6742
@node M2 Checks
6743
@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6744
@cindex Modula-2 checks
6745
 
6746
@quotation
6747
@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6748
range checking.
6749
@end quotation
6750
@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6751
 
6752
@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6753
 
6754
@itemize @bullet
6755
@item
6756
They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6757
@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6758
 
6759
@item
6760
They have been declared on the same line.  (Note:  This is true of the
6761
@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6762
@end itemize
6763
 
6764
As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6765
whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6766
 
6767
Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6768
index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6769
 
6770
@node M2 Scope
6771
@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6772
@cindex scope
6773
@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
6774
@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6775
@ifinfo
6776
@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
6777
@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6778
@end ifinfo
6779
@iftex
6780
@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
6781
@end iftex
6782
 
6783
There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6784
(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}).  The two have
6785
similar syntax:
6786
 
6787
@example
6788
 
6789
@var{module} . @var{id}
6790
@var{scope} :: @var{id}
6791
@end example
6792
 
6793
@noindent
6794
where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6795
@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6796
identifier within your program, except another module.
6797
 
6798
Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6799
specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}.  If it is not
6800
found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6801
enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6802
 
6803
Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6804
the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6805
definition module specified by @var{module}.  With this operator, it is
6806
an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6807
module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6808
@var{module}.
6809
 
6810
@node GDB/M2
6811
@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6812
 
6813
Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6814
Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6815
specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6816
@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}.  The first four
6817
apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6818
analogue in Modula-2.
6819
 
6820
The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
6821
with any language, is not useful with Modula-2.  Its
6822
intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6823
created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++.  However, because an
6824
address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
6825
@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
6826
 
6827
@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6828
In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6829
interpreted as the beginning of a comment.  Use @code{<>} instead.
6830
 
6831
@node Chill
6832
@subsection Chill
6833
 
6834
The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
6835
from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler.  Other Chill compilers are not currently
6836
supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6837
likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6838
table.
6839
 
6840
@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6841
@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6842
This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
6843
of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6844
 
6845
@menu
6846
* How modes are displayed::        How modes are displayed
6847
* Locations::                        Locations and their accesses
6848
* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
6849
* Chill type and range checks::
6850
* Chill defaults::
6851
@end menu
6852
 
6853
@node How modes are displayed
6854
@subsubsection How modes are displayed
6855
 
6856
The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
6857
with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
6858
slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
6859
provided modes are:
6860
 
6861
@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
6862
@c on every @item.  So why does it need @code?
6863
@table @code
6864
@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
6865
@itemize @bullet
6866
@item
6867
@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
6868
UINT, LONG, ULONG},
6869
@item
6870
@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
6871
@item
6872
@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
6873
@item
6874
@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
6875
@smallexample
6876
(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6877
type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6878
@end smallexample
6879
If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
6880
@item
6881
@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
6882
@smallexample
6883
@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
6884
@end smallexample
6885
where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
6886
expression (e.g. set element names).
6887
@end itemize
6888
 
6889
@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
6890
A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
6891
the member mode of the powerset.  The member mode can be any discrete mode.
6892
@smallexample
6893
(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6894
type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
6895
@end smallexample
6896
 
6897
@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
6898
@itemize @bullet
6899
@item
6900
@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
6901
followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
6902
@item
6903
@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
6904
@end itemize
6905
 
6906
@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
6907
The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
6908
<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
6909
list>} is a list of the parameter modes.  @code{<return mode>} indicates
6910
the mode of the result of the procedure if any.  The exceptionlist lists
6911
all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
6912
 
6913
@ignore
6914
@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
6915
The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
6916
type, and is therefore not really of interest.
6917
@end ignore
6918
 
6919
@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
6920
@itemize @bullet
6921
@item
6922
@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
6923
@smallexample
6924
@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
6925
@end smallexample
6926
where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
6927
@item
6928
@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
6929
@smallexample
6930
@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
6931
@end smallexample
6932
where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
6933
@end itemize
6934
 
6935
@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
6936
@itemize @bullet
6937
@item
6938
@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
6939
@item
6940
@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
6941
@end itemize
6942
 
6943
@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
6944
Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
6945
 
6946
@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
6947
@itemize @bullet
6948
@item
6949
@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
6950
@smallexample
6951
@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
6952
@end smallexample
6953
followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
6954
mode
6955
@item
6956
@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
6957
@smallexample
6958
@code{BOOLS(<string
6959
length>)}
6960
@end smallexample
6961
@end itemize
6962
 
6963
@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
6964
The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
6965
followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
6966
@smallexample
6967
(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6968
type = ARRAY (1:42)
6969
          ARRAY (1:20)
6970
             SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6971
@end smallexample
6972
 
6973
@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
6974
The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
6975
list>)}.  The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
6976
of the structure.  Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
6977
OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list.  Since the current version
6978
of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
6979
checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
6980
always displays all variant fields.
6981
@smallexample
6982
(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
6983
type = STRUCT (
6984
    as x,
6985
    bs x,
6986
    CASE bs OF
6987
    (karli):
6988
        cs a
6989
    (ott):
6990
        ds x
6991
    ESAC
6992
)
6993
@end smallexample
6994
@end table
6995
 
6996
@node Locations
6997
@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
6998
 
6999
A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7000
 
7001
A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
7002
the location.  The output conforms to the specification of values in
7003
Chill programs.  How values are specified
7004
is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
7005
 
7006
The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7007
display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
7008
 
7009
@smallexample
7010
set result := EXPR
7011
@end smallexample
7012
 
7013
@noindent
7014
This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
7015
is not available in @value{GDBN}).
7016
 
7017
Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7018
value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
7019
mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference.  @code{<hex value>}
7020
represents the address where the reference points to.  To access the
7021
value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
7022
operator @samp{->}.
7023
 
7024
Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7025
@smallexample
7026
@code{@{ PROC
7027
(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
7028
location>}
7029
@end smallexample
7030
@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7031
specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7032
the entry point.
7033
 
7034
@ignore
7035
Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7036
fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7037
the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
7038
implementation of instances.  They are implemented as a structure (no
7039
na).  The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7040
<instance number>]}.}.  The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
7041
@code{__proc_copy}.
7042
 
7043
Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7044
the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7045
like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7046
mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7047
 
7048
Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
7049
...]}.  The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
7050
definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
7051
of the field.  If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7052
structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7053
braces (@samp{@{@}}).  Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
7054
on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
7055
memory location in their specific modes.  Since no tag processing is done
7056
all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
7057
@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}.  (who implements the
7058
stuff ???)
7059
@smallexample
7060
(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7061
[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7062
@end smallexample
7063
@end ignore
7064
 
7065
Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7066
(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
7067
certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7068
and their Operations}.
7069
 
7070
A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
7071
location conversion.  This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7072
name>(<location>)}.  The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7073
have to be equal otherwise an error occurs.  Furthermore, no range
7074
checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
7075
therefore the result can be quite confusing.
7076
 
7077
@smallexample
7078
(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7079
@end smallexample
7080
 
7081
@node Values and their Operations
7082
@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7083
 
7084
Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7085
more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
7086
data.  There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7087
such investigations.  These operations are not only applicable to
7088
constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
7089
when debugging complex structures.  During parsing the command line
7090
(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7091
the values behind these locations.
7092
 
7093
This section describes how values have to be specified and which
7094
operations are legal to be used with such values.
7095
 
7096
@table @code
7097
@item Literal Values
7098
Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7099
For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
7100
chapter 1.5.
7101
@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7102
@c be converted to a @ref.
7103
 
7104
@ignore
7105
@itemize @bullet
7106
@item
7107
@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7108
programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
7109
@item
7110
@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7111
@item
7112
@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7113
@code{'M'})
7114
@item
7115
@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
7116
mode.  The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value.  This is
7117
comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
7118
@item
7119
@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}.  The value of the
7120
emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
7121
procedure value or the empty instance value.
7122
 
7123
@item
7124
@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
7125
enclosed in single- or double quotes.  If a single- or double quote has
7126
to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7127
@item
7128
@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7129
programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7130
@item
7131
@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
7132
(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
7133
@end itemize
7134
@end ignore
7135
 
7136
@item Tuple Values
7137
A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
7138
name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous.  This
7139
unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7140
@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
7141
 
7142
@itemize @bullet
7143
@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7144
@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7145
@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7146
Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
7147
same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
7148
@end itemize
7149
 
7150
@item String Element Value
7151
A string element value is specified by
7152
@smallexample
7153
@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7154
@end smallexample
7155
where @code{<index>} is a integer expression.  It delivers a character
7156
value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7157
the string.
7158
 
7159
@item String Slice Value
7160
A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7161
spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7162
expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7163
@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7164
The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7165
string.
7166
 
7167
@item Array Element Values
7168
An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7169
delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7170
 
7171
@item Array Slice Values
7172
An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7173
@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
7174
@code{<start expr> up <size>}.  @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7175
arrayelements the slice contains.  The delivered value is an array value
7176
which is part of the specified array.
7177
 
7178
@item Structure Field Values
7179
A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
7180
name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7181
in the mode definition of the structure.  The mode of the delivered value
7182
corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7183
 
7184
@item Procedure Call Value
7185
The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7186
procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7187
expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
7188
effects.  This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
7189
 
7190
Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
7191
 
7192
Values of time mode locations appear as
7193
@smallexample
7194
@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7195
@end smallexample
7196
 
7197
 
7198
@ignore
7199
This is not implemented yet:
7200
@item Built-in Value
7201
@noindent
7202
The following built in functions are provided:
7203
 
7204
@table @code
7205
@item @code{ADDR()}
7206
@item @code{NUM()}
7207
@item @code{PRED()}
7208
@item @code{SUCC()}
7209
@item @code{ABS()}
7210
@item @code{CARD()}
7211
@item @code{MAX()}
7212
@item @code{MIN()}
7213
@item @code{SIZE()}
7214
@item @code{UPPER()}
7215
@item @code{LOWER()}
7216
@item @code{LENGTH()}
7217
@item @code{SIN()}
7218
@item @code{COS()}
7219
@item @code{TAN()}
7220
@item @code{ARCSIN()}
7221
@item @code{ARCCOS()}
7222
@item @code{ARCTAN()}
7223
@item @code{EXP()}
7224
@item @code{LN()}
7225
@item @code{LOG()}
7226
@item @code{SQRT()}
7227
@end table
7228
 
7229
For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
7230
chapter 1.6.
7231
@end ignore
7232
 
7233
@item Zero-adic Operator Value
7234
The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
7235
current active process.
7236
 
7237
@item Expression Values
7238
The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
7239
the specified expression.  If there are error conditions (mode
7240
incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
7241
corresponding error message.  Expressions may be parenthesised which
7242
causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
7243
which uses the result of the parenthesised expression.  The following
7244
operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
7245
 
7246
@table @code
7247
@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
7248
@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7249
@itemx @code{NOT}
7250
Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
7251
 
7252
@item @code{=, /=}
7253
Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
7254
 
7255
@item @code{>, >=}
7256
@itemx @code{<, <=}
7257
Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
7258
 
7259
@item @code{+, -}
7260
@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
7261
Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
7262
 
7263
@item @code{-}
7264
Change sign operator.
7265
 
7266
@item @code{//}
7267
String concatenation operator.
7268
 
7269
@item @code{()}
7270
String repetition operator.
7271
 
7272
@item @code{->}
7273
Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7274
address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7275
location (@code{loc->}).
7276
 
7277
@item @code{OR, XOR}
7278
@itemx @code{AND}
7279
@itemx @code{NOT}
7280
Powerset and bitstring operators.
7281
 
7282
@item @code{>, >=}
7283
@itemx @code{<, <=}
7284
Powerset inclusion operators.
7285
 
7286
@item @code{IN}
7287
Membership operator.
7288
@end table
7289
@end table
7290
 
7291
@node Chill type and range checks
7292
@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7293
 
7294
@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
7295
of the two modes are equal.  This rule applies recursively to more
7296
complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
7297
equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
7298
structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7299
 
7300
Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7301
index bounds and all built in procedures.
7302
 
7303
Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
7304
check strong}.  This enforces strong type and range checks on all
7305
operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7306
functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7307
language specification.
7308
 
7309
All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7310
off}.
7311
 
7312
@ignore
7313
@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
7314
see last paragraph ?
7315
@end ignore
7316
 
7317
@node Chill defaults
7318
@subsubsection Chill defaults
7319
 
7320
If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7321
both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
7322
Chill.  This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
7323
selected the working language.
7324
 
7325
If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7326
code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
7327
working language to Chill.  @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
7328
the language automatically}, for further details.
7329
 
7330
@node Symbols
7331
@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7332
 
7333
The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
7334
symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7335
program.  This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7336
does not change as your program executes.  @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7337
program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7338
(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7339
file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7340
 
7341
@cindex symbol names
7342
@cindex names of symbols
7343
@cindex quoting names
7344
Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7345
characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters.  The
7346
most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7347
source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}).  File names
7348
are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7349
ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7350
@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}.  To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7351
@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7352
 
7353
@example
7354
p 'foo.c'::x
7355
@end example
7356
 
7357
@noindent
7358
looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7359
 
7360
@table @code
7361
@kindex info address
7362
@item info address @var{symbol}
7363
Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored.  For a register
7364
variable, this says which register it is kept in.  For a non-register
7365
local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7366
is always stored.
7367
 
7368
Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7369
at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7370
the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7371
 
7372
@kindex whatis
7373
@item whatis @var{expr}
7374
Print the data type of expression @var{expr}.  @var{expr} is not
7375
actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7376
assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7377
@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7378
 
7379
@item whatis
7380
Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7381
 
7382
@kindex ptype
7383
@item ptype @var{typename}
7384
Print a description of data type @var{typename}.  @var{typename} may be
7385
the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7386
@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7387
@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
7388
 
7389
@item ptype @var{expr}
7390
@itemx ptype
7391
Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}.  @code{ptype}
7392
differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7393
of just the name of the type.
7394
 
7395
For example, for this variable declaration:
7396
 
7397
@example
7398
struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7399
@end example
7400
 
7401
@noindent
7402
the two commands give this output:
7403
 
7404
@example
7405
@group
7406
(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7407
type = struct complex
7408
(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7409
type = struct complex @{
7410
    double real;
7411
    double imag;
7412
@}
7413
@end group
7414
@end example
7415
 
7416
@noindent
7417
As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7418
the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7419
 
7420
@kindex info types
7421
@item info types @var{regexp}
7422
@itemx info types
7423
Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
7424
(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument).  Each
7425
complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7426
@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
7427
names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
7428
information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7429
 
7430
This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7431
@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7432
lists all source files where a type is defined.
7433
 
7434
@kindex info source
7435
@item info source
7436
Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7437
the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7438
it was written in.
7439
 
7440
@kindex info sources
7441
@item info sources
7442
Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7443
debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7444
have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7445
 
7446
@kindex info functions
7447
@item info functions
7448
Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7449
 
7450
@item info functions @var{regexp}
7451
Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7452
whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7453
Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7454
include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7455
start with @code{step}.
7456
 
7457
@kindex info variables
7458
@item info variables
7459
Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7460
outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7461
 
7462
@item info variables @var{regexp}
7463
Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7464
variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7465
@var{regexp}.
7466
 
7467
@ignore
7468
This was never implemented.
7469
@kindex info methods
7470
@item info methods
7471
@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7472
The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7473
methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7474
specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes.  Many
7475
C++ classes provide a large number of methods.  Thus, the output
7476
from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use.  The
7477
@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7478
which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7479
@end ignore
7480
 
7481
@cindex reloading symbols
7482
Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7483
be replaced without stopping and restarting your program.  For example,
7484
in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7485
running.  If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7486
@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
7487
 
7488
@table @code
7489
@kindex set symbol-reloading
7490
@item set symbol-reloading on
7491
Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7492
object file with a particular name is seen again.
7493
 
7494
@item set symbol-reloading off
7495
Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
7496
same name more than once.  This is the default state; if you are not
7497
running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
7498
should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
7499
may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
7500
several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
7501
name.
7502
 
7503
@kindex show symbol-reloading
7504
@item show symbol-reloading
7505
Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7506
@end table
7507
 
7508
@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7509
@item set opaque-type-resolution on
7510
Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types.  An opaque type is a type
7511
declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7512
@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7513
source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7514
another source file.  The default is on.
7515
 
7516
A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7517
the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7518
 
7519
@item set opaque-type-resolution off
7520
Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types.  In this case, the type
7521
is printed as follows:
7522
@smallexample
7523
@{<no data fields>@}
7524
@end smallexample
7525
 
7526
@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7527
@item show opaque-type-resolution
7528
Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
7529
 
7530
@kindex maint print symbols
7531
@cindex symbol dump
7532
@kindex maint print psymbols
7533
@cindex partial symbol dump
7534
@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7535
@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7536
@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7537
Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7538
These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.  Only
7539
symbols with debugging data are included.  If you use @samp{maint print
7540
symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7541
collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7542
only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read.  You can use the
7543
command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.  If you
7544
use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7545
symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7546
files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.  Finally,
7547
@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7548
required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7549
@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7550
@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7551
@end table
7552
 
7553
@node Altering
7554
@chapter Altering Execution
7555
 
7556
Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7557
find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7558
correct results in the rest of the run.  You can find the answer by
7559
experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7560
program.
7561
 
7562
For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7563
locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7564
address, or even return prematurely from a function.
7565
 
7566
@menu
7567
* Assignment::                  Assignment to variables
7568
* Jumping::                     Continuing at a different address
7569
* Signaling::                   Giving your program a signal
7570
* Returning::                   Returning from a function
7571
* Calling::                     Calling your program's functions
7572
* Patching::                    Patching your program
7573
@end menu
7574
 
7575
@node Assignment
7576
@section Assignment to variables
7577
 
7578
@cindex assignment
7579
@cindex setting variables
7580
To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7581
@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.  For example,
7582
 
7583
@example
7584
print x=4
7585
@end example
7586
 
7587
@noindent
7588
stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
7589
value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
7590
@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7591
information on operators in supported languages.
7592
 
7593
@kindex set variable
7594
@cindex variables, setting
7595
If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7596
@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command.  @code{set} is
7597
really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7598
not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7599
,Value history}).  The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7600
 
7601
If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7602
appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7603
variable} command instead of just @code{set}.  This command is identical
7604
to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands.  For example, if your
7605
program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7606
a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7607
command @code{set width}:
7608
 
7609
@example
7610
(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7611
type = double
7612
(@value{GDBP}) p width
7613
$4 = 13
7614
(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7615
Invalid syntax in expression.
7616
@end example
7617
 
7618
@noindent
7619
The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}.  In
7620
order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7621
 
7622
@example
7623
(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7624
@end example
7625
 
7626
Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7627
with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7628
@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}.  For example, if
7629
your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7630
to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7631
the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7632
 
7633
@example
7634
@group
7635
(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7636
type = double
7637
(@value{GDBP}) p g
7638
$1 = 1
7639
(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
7640
(@value{GDBP}) p g
7641
$2 = 1
7642
(@value{GDBP}) r
7643
The program being debugged has been started already.
7644
Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7645
Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
7646
"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
7647
                                 Invalid bfd target.
7648
(@value{GDBP}) show g
7649
The current BFD target is "=4".
7650
@end group
7651
@end example
7652
 
7653
@noindent
7654
The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7655
@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value.  In order to set the variable
7656
@code{g}, use
7657
 
7658
@example
7659
(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7660
@end example
7661
 
7662
@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7663
freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7664
and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7665
same length or shorter.
7666
@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7667
@comment        /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7668
 
7669
To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7670
construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7671
(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7672
to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7673
and representation in memory), and
7674
 
7675
@example
7676
set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7677
@end example
7678
 
7679
@noindent
7680
stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7681
 
7682
@node Jumping
7683
@section Continuing at a different address
7684
 
7685
Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7686
it stopped, with the @code{continue} command.  You can instead continue at
7687
an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7688
 
7689
@table @code
7690
@kindex jump
7691
@item jump @var{linespec}
7692
Resume execution at line @var{linespec}.  Execution stops again
7693
immediately if there is a breakpoint there.  @xref{List, ,Printing
7694
source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7695
@var{linespec}.  It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7696
in conjunction with @code{jump}.  @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7697
breakpoints}.
7698
 
7699
The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7700
the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7701
register other than the program counter.  If line @var{linespec} is in
7702
a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7703
be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7704
of local variables.  For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7705
confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7706
executing.  However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7707
well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7708
 
7709
@item jump *@var{address}
7710
Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7711
@end table
7712
 
7713
@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
7714
On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7715
command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}.  The
7716
difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7717
changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue.  For
7718
example,
7719
 
7720
@example
7721
set $pc = 0x485
7722
@end example
7723
 
7724
@noindent
7725
makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7726
address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7727
@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
7728
 
7729
The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7730
up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7731
that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7732
detail.
7733
 
7734
@c @group
7735
@node Signaling
7736
@section Giving your program a signal
7737
 
7738
@table @code
7739
@kindex signal
7740
@item signal @var{signal}
7741
Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7742
signal @var{signal}.  @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7743
signal.  For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7744
SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7745
 
7746
Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7747
giving a signal.  This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7748
a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7749
@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7750
signal.
7751
 
7752
@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7753
after executing the command.
7754
@end table
7755
@c @end group
7756
 
7757
Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7758
@code{kill} utility from the shell.  Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7759
causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7760
the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}).  The @code{signal} command
7761
passes the signal directly to your program.
7762
 
7763
 
7764
@node Returning
7765
@section Returning from a function
7766
 
7767
@table @code
7768
@cindex returning from a function
7769
@kindex return
7770
@item return
7771
@itemx return @var{expression}
7772
You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7773
command.  If you give an
7774
@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7775
value.
7776
@end table
7777
 
7778
When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7779
(and all frames within it).  You can think of this as making the
7780
discarded frame return prematurely.  If you wish to specify a value to
7781
be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7782
 
7783
This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7784
frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7785
innermost remaining frame.  That frame becomes selected.  The
7786
specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7787
of functions.
7788
 
7789
The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7790
program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7791
returned.  In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7792
and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7793
selected stack frame returns naturally.
7794
 
7795
@node Calling
7796
@section Calling program functions
7797
 
7798
@cindex calling functions
7799
@kindex call
7800
@table @code
7801
@item call @var{expr}
7802
Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7803
returned values.
7804
@end table
7805
 
7806
You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7807
execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
7808
with @code{void} returned values.  If the result is not void, it
7809
is printed and saved in the value history.
7810
 
7811
For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7812
specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7813
calls a function in the target.  This is necessary because the usual
7814
method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7815
that have separate instruction and data spaces.
7816
 
7817
@node Patching
7818
@section Patching programs
7819
 
7820
@cindex patching binaries
7821
@cindex writing into executables
7822
@cindex writing into corefiles
7823
 
7824
By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7825
executable code (or the corefile) read-only.  This prevents accidental
7826
alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7827
patching your program's binary.
7828
 
7829
If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7830
explicitly with the @code{set write} command.  For example, you might
7831
want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7832
repairs.
7833
 
7834
@table @code
7835
@kindex set write
7836
@item set write on
7837
@itemx set write off
7838
If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7839
core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
7840
off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7841
 
7842
If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7843
@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7844
write}, for your new setting to take effect.
7845
 
7846
@item show write
7847
@kindex show write
7848
Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
7849
as well as reading.
7850
@end table
7851
 
7852
@node GDB Files
7853
@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
7854
 
7855
@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
7856
both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
7857
program.  To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
7858
@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
7859
 
7860
@menu
7861
* Files::                       Commands to specify files
7862
* Symbol Errors::               Errors reading symbol files
7863
@end menu
7864
 
7865
@node Files
7866
@section Commands to specify files
7867
 
7868
@cindex symbol table
7869
@cindex core dump file
7870
 
7871
You may want to specify executable and core dump file names.  The usual
7872
way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
7873
@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
7874
Out of @value{GDBN}}).
7875
 
7876
Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
7877
@value{GDBN} session.  Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
7878
a file you want to use.  In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
7879
to specify new files are useful.
7880
 
7881
@table @code
7882
@cindex executable file
7883
@kindex file
7884
@item file @var{filename}
7885
Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged.  It is read for its
7886
symbols and for the contents of pure memory.  It is also the program
7887
executed when you use the @code{run} command.  If you do not specify a
7888
directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
7889
@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
7890
directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
7891
to run.  You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
7892
and your program, using the @code{path} command.
7893
 
7894
On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
7895
@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
7896
@var{filename}.  If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
7897
@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly.  See the
7898
descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
7899
(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
7900
@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
7901
for more information.
7902
 
7903
@item file
7904
@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
7905
has on both executable file and the symbol table.
7906
 
7907
@kindex exec-file
7908
@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7909
Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
7910
in @var{filename}.  @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
7911
if necessary to locate your program.  Omitting @var{filename} means to
7912
discard information on the executable file.
7913
 
7914
@kindex symbol-file
7915
@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7916
Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}.  @code{PATH} is
7917
searched when necessary.  Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
7918
table and program to run from the same file.
7919
 
7920
@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
7921
program's symbol table.
7922
 
7923
The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
7924
of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
7925
auto-display expressions.  This is because they may contain pointers to
7926
the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
7927
the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
7928
 
7929
@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
7930
executing it once.
7931
 
7932
When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
7933
understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
7934
generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
7935
other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
7936
Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
7937
using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
7938
optimized code.
7939
 
7940
For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
7941
using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
7942
symbol table in full right away.  Instead, it scans the symbol table
7943
quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present.  The
7944
details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
7945
 
7946
The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
7947
start up faster.  For the most part, it is invisible except for
7948
occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
7949
file are being read.  (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
7950
pauses into messages if desired.  @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
7951
warnings and messages}.)
7952
 
7953
We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet.  When the
7954
symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
7955
symbol table data in full right away.  Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
7956
still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
7957
in stabs format.
7958
 
7959
@kindex readnow
7960
@cindex reading symbols immediately
7961
@cindex symbols, reading immediately
7962
@kindex mapped
7963
@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
7964
@cindex saving symbol table
7965
@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7966
@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7967
You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
7968
tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
7969
load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
7970
entire symbol table available.
7971
 
7972
If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
7973
@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
7974
cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
7975
file.  Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
7976
from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
7977
than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
7978
program.  Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
7979
starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
7980
 
7981
You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
7982
file has all the symbol information for your program.
7983
 
7984
The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
7985
@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}.  Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
7986
than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
7987
it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
7988
needed.
7989
 
7990
The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
7991
@value{GDBN}.  It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
7992
symbol table.  It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
7993
 
7994
@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
7995
@c flux.  13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
7996
@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
7997
@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
7998
@c only current dir is used.  FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
7999
@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8000
@c files.
8001
 
8002
@kindex core
8003
@kindex core-file
8004
@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8005
Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8006
of memory''.  Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8007
address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8008
executable file itself for other parts.
8009
 
8010
@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8011
to be used.
8012
 
8013
Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
8014
under @value{GDBN}.  So, if you have been running your program and you
8015
wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8016
the program is running.  To do this, use the @code{kill} command
8017
(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
8018
 
8019
@kindex add-symbol-file
8020
@cindex dynamic linking
8021
@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8022
@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8023
@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @var{data_address} @var{bss_address}
8024
@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}
8025
The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8026
information from the file @var{filename}.  You would use this command
8027
when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8028
into the program that is running.  @var{address} should be the memory
8029
address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
8030
this out for itself.  You can specify up to three addresses, in which
8031
case they are taken to be the addresses of the text, data, and bss
8032
segments respectively.  For complicated cases, you can specify an
8033
arbitrary number of @samp{@r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to
8034
give an explicit section name and base address for that section.  You
8035
can specify any @var{address} as an expression.
8036
 
8037
The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8038
originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command.  You can use the
8039
@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8040
thus read keeps adding to the old.  To discard all old symbol data
8041
instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
8042
 
8043
@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8044
 
8045
You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8046
the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8047
table information for @var{filename}.
8048
 
8049
@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8050
@item add-shared-symbol-file
8051
The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
8052
operating system for the Motorola 88k.  @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8053
shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
8054
@code{add-shared-symbol-file}.  It takes no arguments.
8055
 
8056
@kindex section
8057
@item section
8058
The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8059
the exec file to ADDR.  This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8060
section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8061
specified in the file itself are wrong.  Each section must be changed
8062
separately.  The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8063
the sections and their addresses.
8064
 
8065
@kindex info files
8066
@kindex info target
8067
@item info files
8068
@itemx info target
8069
@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8070
current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8071
including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8072
use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded.  The
8073
command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8074
current ones.
8075
 
8076
@end table
8077
 
8078
All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8079
as arguments.  @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8080
name and remembers it that way.
8081
 
8082
@cindex shared libraries
8083
@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8084
libraries.
8085
 
8086
@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8087
when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8088
(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8089
references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8090
debugging a core file).
8091
 
8092
On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8093
automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8094
 
8095
@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8096
@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8097
@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8098
 
8099
@table @code
8100
@kindex info sharedlibrary
8101
@kindex info share
8102
@item info share
8103
@itemx info sharedlibrary
8104
Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8105
 
8106
@kindex sharedlibrary
8107
@kindex share
8108
@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8109
@itemx share @var{regex}
8110
Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8111
Unix regular expression.
8112
As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8113
required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}.  If
8114
@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8115
loaded.
8116
@end table
8117
 
8118
On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8119
and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8120
a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
8121
 
8122
Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
8123
loaded.  To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8124
@var{filename}}.  The base address of the shared library is determined
8125
automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8126
 
8127
To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8128
 
8129
@table @code
8130
@kindex set auto-solib-add
8131
@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8132
Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.  If @var{threshold} is
8133
nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8134
automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8135
linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8136
the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8137
Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8138
@code{sharedlibrary} command.  The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8139
 
8140
@kindex show auto-solib-add
8141
@item show auto-solib-add
8142
Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8143
@end table
8144
 
8145
@node Symbol Errors
8146
@section Errors reading symbol files
8147
 
8148
While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8149
such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8150
output.  By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8151
they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8152
debugging compilers.  If you are interested in seeing information
8153
about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8154
only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8155
times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8156
to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8157
complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8158
messages}).
8159
 
8160
The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8161
 
8162
@table @code
8163
@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8164
 
8165
The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8166
(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements).  This
8167
error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8168
in its outer scope blocks.
8169
 
8170
@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8171
the same scope as the outer block.  In the error message, @var{symbol}
8172
may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8173
function.
8174
 
8175
@item block at @var{address} out of order
8176
 
8177
The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
8178
order of increasing addresses.  This error indicates that it does not
8179
do so.
8180
 
8181
@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
8182
locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading.  (You
8183
can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
8184
@code{set verbose on}.  @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8185
messages}.)
8186
 
8187
@item bad block start address patched
8188
 
8189
The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
8190
smaller than the address of the preceding source line.  This is known
8191
to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
8192
 
8193
@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
8194
starting on the previous source line.
8195
 
8196
@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
8197
 
8198
@cindex foo
8199
Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
8200
larger than the size of the string table.
8201
 
8202
@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
8203
name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
8204
with this name.
8205
 
8206
@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
8207
 
8208
The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
8209
not yet know how to read.  @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
8210
uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
8211
 
8212
@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
8213
This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
8214
are not accessible.  If you encounter such a problem and feel like
8215
debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
8216
on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
8217
and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
8218
 
8219
@item stub type has NULL name
8220
 
8221
@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
8222
 
8223
@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
8224
The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
8225
information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
8226
it.
8227
 
8228
@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
8229
 
8230
@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
8231
 
8232
@end table
8233
 
8234
@node Targets
8235
@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
8236
 
8237
@cindex debugging target
8238
@kindex target
8239
 
8240
A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
8241
 
8242
Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8243
in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8244
you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands.  When you need more
8245
flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8246
host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
8247
realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8248
command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8249
(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
8250
 
8251
@menu
8252
* Active Targets::              Active targets
8253
* Target Commands::             Commands for managing targets
8254
* Byte Order::                  Choosing target byte order
8255
* Remote::                      Remote debugging
8256
* KOD::                         Kernel Object Display
8257
 
8258
@end menu
8259
 
8260
@node Active Targets
8261
@section Active targets
8262
 
8263
@cindex stacking targets
8264
@cindex active targets
8265
@cindex multiple targets
8266
 
8267
There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
8268
executable files.  @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8269
active targets, one in each class.  This allows you to (for example)
8270
start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8271
a core file.
8272
 
8273
For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8274
@code{a.out} is the only active target.  If you designate a core file as
8275
well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8276
@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8277
first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8278
requests for memory addresses.  (Typically, these two classes of target
8279
are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8280
read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8281
executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
8282
 
8283
When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
8284
target as well.  When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8285
commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8286
an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8287
process target is active.
8288
 
8289
Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8290
core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
8291
files}).  To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
8292
the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8293
process}).
8294
 
8295
@node Target Commands
8296
@section Commands for managing targets
8297
 
8298
@table @code
8299
@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
8300
Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8301
process.  A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8302
facilities.  You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8303
protocol of the target machine.
8304
 
8305
Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8306
typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8307
with, process numbers, and baud rates.
8308
 
8309
The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8310
after executing the command.
8311
 
8312
@kindex help target
8313
@item help target
8314
Displays the names of all targets available.  To display targets
8315
currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8316
(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8317
 
8318
@item help target @var{name}
8319
Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8320
select it.
8321
 
8322
@kindex set gnutarget
8323
@item set gnutarget @var{args}
8324
@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files.  @value{GDBN}
8325
knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
8326
a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8327
with the @code{set gnutarget} command.  Unlike most @code{target} commands,
8328
with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8329
 
8330
@quotation
8331
@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8332
you must know the actual BFD name.
8333
@end quotation
8334
 
8335
@noindent
8336
@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
8337
 
8338
@kindex show gnutarget
8339
@item show gnutarget
8340
Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8341
@code{gnutarget} is set to read.  If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8342
@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8343
and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8344
@end table
8345
 
8346
Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8347
configuration):
8348
 
8349
@table @code
8350
@kindex target exec
8351
@item target exec @var{program}
8352
An executable file.  @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8353
@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8354
 
8355
@kindex target core
8356
@item target core @var{filename}
8357
A core dump file.  @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8358
@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
8359
 
8360
@kindex target remote
8361
@item target remote @var{dev}
8362
Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol.  The argument @var{dev}
8363
specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8364
@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}.  @code{target remote}
8365
supports the @code{load} command.  This is only useful if you have
8366
some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8367
it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8368
 
8369
@kindex target sim
8370
@item target sim
8371
Builtin CPU simulator.  @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
8372
In general,
8373
@example
8374
        target sim
8375
        load
8376
        run
8377
@end example
8378
@noindent
8379
works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
8380
drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
8381
provide these.  For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8382
see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8383
Processors}.
8384
 
8385
@end table
8386
 
8387
Some configurations may include these targets as well:
8388
 
8389
@table @code
8390
 
8391
@kindex target nrom
8392
@item target nrom @var{dev}
8393
NetROM ROM emulator.  This target only supports downloading.
8394
 
8395
@end table
8396
 
8397
Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
8398
your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
8399
 
8400
Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8401
once you've successfully established a connection.
8402
 
8403
@table @code
8404
 
8405
@kindex load @var{filename}
8406
@item load @var{filename}
8407
Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8408
@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available.  Where it exists, it
8409
is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8410
on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8411
@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8412
the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8413
 
8414
If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8415
execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8416
target is @dots{}}''
8417
 
8418
The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8419
For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8420
link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8421
specifies a fixed address.
8422
@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8423
 
8424
@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8425
@end table
8426
 
8427
@node Byte Order
8428
@section Choosing target byte order
8429
 
8430
@cindex choosing target byte order
8431
@cindex target byte order
8432
 
8433
Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8434
offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8435
orders.  Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8436
designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8437
which to use.  However, you may still find it useful to adjust
8438
@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
8439
 
8440
@table @code
8441
@kindex set endian big
8442
@item set endian big
8443
Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8444
 
8445
@kindex set endian little
8446
@item set endian little
8447
Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8448
 
8449
@kindex set endian auto
8450
@item set endian auto
8451
Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8452
executable.
8453
 
8454
@item show endian
8455
Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8456
 
8457
@end table
8458
 
8459
Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8460
data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8461
target system.
8462
 
8463
@node Remote
8464
@section Remote debugging
8465
@cindex remote debugging
8466
 
8467
If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
8468
@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8469
For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
8470
or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8471
powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8472
 
8473
Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8474
to make this work with particular debugging targets.  In addition,
8475
@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
8476
but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8477
write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8478
communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8479
 
8480
Other remote targets may be available in your
8481
configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
8482
 
8483
@menu
8484
* Remote Serial::               @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
8485
@end menu
8486
 
8487
@node Remote Serial
8488
@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
8489
 
8490
@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8491
To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8492
@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8493
prerequisites for the program to run by itself.  For example, for a C
8494
program, you need:
8495
 
8496
@enumerate
8497
@item
8498
A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8499
have a name like @file{crt0}.  The startup routine may be supplied by
8500
your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
8501
 
8502
@item
8503
A C subroutine library to support your program's
8504
subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
8505
 
8506
@item
8507
A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8508
download program.  These are often supplied by the hardware
8509
manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8510
documentation.
8511
@end enumerate
8512
 
8513
The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8514
communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8515
machine).  In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
8516
 
8517
@table @emph
8518
@item On the host,
8519
@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8520
else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8521
(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8522
 
8523
@item On the target,
8524
you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8525
implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.  The file containing these
8526
subroutines is called  a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8527
 
8528
On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8529
@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8530
@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8531
@end table
8532
 
8533
The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8534
machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8535
@sc{sparc} boards.
8536
 
8537
@cindex remote serial stub list
8538
These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
8539
 
8540
@table @code
8541
 
8542
@item i386-stub.c
8543
@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
8544
@cindex Intel
8545
@cindex i386
8546
For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8547
 
8548
@item m68k-stub.c
8549
@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
8550
@cindex Motorola 680x0
8551
@cindex m680x0
8552
For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8553
 
8554
@item sh-stub.c
8555
@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
8556
@cindex Hitachi
8557
@cindex SH
8558
For Hitachi SH architectures.
8559
 
8560
@item sparc-stub.c
8561
@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
8562
@cindex Sparc
8563
For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8564
 
8565
@item sparcl-stub.c
8566
@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
8567
@cindex Fujitsu
8568
@cindex SparcLite
8569
For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8570
 
8571
@end table
8572
 
8573
The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8574
recently added stubs.
8575
 
8576
@menu
8577
* Stub Contents::       What the stub can do for you
8578
* Bootstrapping::       What you must do for the stub
8579
* Debug Session::       Putting it all together
8580
* Protocol::            Definition of the communication protocol
8581
* Server::                Using the `gdbserver' program
8582
* NetWare::                Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8583
@end menu
8584
 
8585
@node Stub Contents
8586
@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8587
 
8588
@cindex remote serial stub
8589
The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8590
subroutines:
8591
 
8592
@table @code
8593
@item set_debug_traps
8594
@kindex set_debug_traps
8595
@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8596
This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8597
program stops.  You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8598
beginning of your program.
8599
 
8600
@item handle_exception
8601
@kindex handle_exception
8602
@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8603
This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8604
explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8605
run when a trap is triggered.
8606
 
8607
@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8608
execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8609
with @value{GDBN} on the host machine.  This is where the communications
8610
protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
8611
representative on the target machine.  It begins by sending summary
8612
information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8613
retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8614
execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8615
@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
8616
machine.
8617
 
8618
@item breakpoint
8619
@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8620
Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8621
breakpoint.  Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8622
way for @value{GDBN} to get control.  For instance, if your target
8623
machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8624
pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8625
@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}.  On some machines,
8626
simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8627
again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8628
your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
8629
@value{GDBN} session gets control.
8630
 
8631
Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8632
to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8633
start of your debugging session.
8634
@end table
8635
 
8636
@node Bootstrapping
8637
@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8638
 
8639
@cindex remote stub, support routines
8640
The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8641
chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8642
debugging target machine.
8643
 
8644
First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8645
serial port.
8646
 
8647
@table @code
8648
@item int getDebugChar()
8649
@kindex getDebugChar
8650
Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8651
It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8652
different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8653
 
8654
@item void putDebugChar(int)
8655
@kindex putDebugChar
8656
Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
8657
It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
8658
different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8659
@end table
8660
 
8661
@cindex control C, and remote debugging
8662
@cindex interrupting remote targets
8663
If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8664
running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8665
for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8666
character).  That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8667
remote system to stop.
8668
 
8669
Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8670
probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8671
is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8672
@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8673
 
8674
Other routines you need to supply are:
8675
 
8676
@table @code
8677
@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8678
@kindex exceptionHandler
8679
Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8680
handling tables.  You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8681
way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8682
are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8683
containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8684
@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8685
its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8686
might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc).  When this
8687
exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8688
@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8689
and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs.  So if
8690
you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8691
should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8692
 
8693
For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8694
gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs.  The gate
8695
should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level).  The
8696
@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8697
help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8698
 
8699
@item void flush_i_cache()
8700
@kindex flush_i_cache
8701
On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
8702
instruction cache, if any, on your target machine.  If there is no
8703
instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8704
 
8705
On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8706
function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8707
@end table
8708
 
8709
@noindent
8710
You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8711
 
8712
@table @code
8713
@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8714
@kindex memset
8715
This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8716
memory to a known value.  If you have one of the free versions of
8717
@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8718
either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8719
@end table
8720
 
8721
If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8722
library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8723
but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
8724
subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
8725
 
8726
 
8727
@node Debug Session
8728
@subsubsection Putting it all together
8729
 
8730
@cindex remote serial debugging summary
8731
In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8732
steps.
8733
 
8734
@enumerate
8735
@item
8736
Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
8737
(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8738
@display
8739
@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8740
@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8741
@end display
8742
 
8743
@item
8744
Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8745
 
8746
@example
8747
set_debug_traps();
8748
breakpoint();
8749
@end example
8750
 
8751
@item
8752
For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8753
@code{exceptionHook}.  Normally you just use:
8754
 
8755
@example
8756
void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8757
@end example
8758
 
8759
@noindent
8760
but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
8761
function in your program, that function is called when
8762
@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8763
error).  The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8764
one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8765
 
8766
@item
8767
Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8768
your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8769
 
8770
@item
8771
Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8772
the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8773
 
8774
@item
8775
@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8776
@c document that.  FIXME.
8777
Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8778
whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8779
 
8780
@item
8781
To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8782
as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8783
This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8784
of its pure text.
8785
 
8786
@item
8787
@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
8788
Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
8789
Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8790
machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8791
TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8792
to the target).  For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8793
device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8794
 
8795
@example
8796
target remote /dev/ttyb
8797
@end example
8798
 
8799
@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8800
To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8801
@code{@var{host}:port}.  For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8802
terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8803
 
8804
@example
8805
target remote manyfarms:2828
8806
@end example
8807
@end enumerate
8808
 
8809
Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8810
step and continue the remote program.
8811
 
8812
To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8813
command.
8814
 
8815
@cindex interrupting remote programs
8816
@cindex remote programs, interrupting
8817
Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8818
interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8819
program.  This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8820
and the serial drivers the remote system uses.  If you type the
8821
interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8822
 
8823
@example
8824
Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8825
Give up (and stop debugging it)?  (y or n)
8826
@end example
8827
 
8828
If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8829
(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8830
remote} again to connect once more.)  If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8831
goes back to waiting.
8832
 
8833
@node Protocol
8834
@subsubsection Communication protocol
8835
 
8836
@cindex debugging stub, example
8837
@cindex remote stub, example
8838
@cindex stub example, remote debugging
8839
The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8840
communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8841
@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}.  Normally, you can simply allow
8842
these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details.  (If you're
8843
implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8844
with one of the existing stub files.  @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8845
organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8846
 
8847
However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8848
the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8849
target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8850
it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8851
 
8852
In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
8853
transmitted and received data respectfully.
8854
 
8855
@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
8856
@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
8857
@cindex remote serial protocol
8858
All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
8859
sent as a @var{packet}.  A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
8860
@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
8861
@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
8862
 
8863
@example
8864
@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8865
@end example
8866
@noindent
8867
 
8868
@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
8869
@noindent
8870
The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
8871
characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
8872
eight bit unsigned checksum).
8873
 
8874
Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
8875
specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
8876
 
8877
@example
8878
@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8879
@end example
8880
 
8881
@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
8882
@noindent
8883
That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment.  @value{GDBN}
8884
has never output @var{sequence-id}s.  Stubs that handle packets added
8885
since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
8886
 
8887
@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
8888
When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
8889
response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
8890
the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
8891
retransmission):
8892
 
8893
@example
8894
<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8895
-> @code{+}
8896
@end example
8897
@noindent
8898
 
8899
The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
8900
debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}.  In
8901
the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
8902
when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
8903
 
8904
@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
8905
exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
8906
exceptions).
8907
 
8908
Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
8909
@samp{:}.  Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
8910
HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
8911
 
8912
Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
8913
@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
8914
would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
8915
 
8916
Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.  A @samp{*}
8917
means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
8918
which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
8919
@samp{*}.  The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
8920
where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win).  The printable
8921
characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
8922
value greater than 126 should not be used.
8923
 
8924
Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
8925
loosely refered to as the cisco encoding.  Following the @samp{*}
8926
character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
8927
 
8928
So:
8929
@example
8930
"@code{0* }"
8931
@end example
8932
@noindent
8933
means the same as "0000".
8934
 
8935
The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
8936
error number.  That number is not well defined.
8937
 
8938
For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
8939
(@samp{$#00}) should be returned.  That way it is possible to extend the
8940
protocol.  A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
8941
on that response.
8942
 
8943
A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
8944
@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s.  All other @var{command}s are
8945
optional.
8946
 
8947
Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
8948
their corresponding response @var{data}:
8949
@page
8950
@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
8951
@item Packet
8952
@tab Request
8953
@tab Description
8954
 
8955
@item extended ops
8956
@tab @code{!}
8957
@tab
8958
Use the extended remote protocol.  Sticky---only needs to be set once.
8959
The extended remote protocol supports the @samp{R} packet.
8960
@item
8961
@tab reply @samp{}
8962
@tab
8963
Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
8964
unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
8965
support protocol extensions.
8966
 
8967
@item last signal
8968
@tab @code{?}
8969
@tab
8970
Indicate the reason the target halted.  The reply is the same as for step
8971
and continue.
8972
@item
8973
@tab reply
8974
@tab see below
8975
 
8976
 
8977
@item reserved
8978
@tab @code{a}
8979
@tab Reserved for future use
8980
 
8981
@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
8982
@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
8983
@tab
8984
@item
8985
@tab
8986
@tab
8987
Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
8988
specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
8989
See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
8990
@item
8991
@tab reply @code{OK}
8992
@item
8993
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8994
 
8995
@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
8996
@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
8997
@tab
8998
Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.  JTC: @emph{When does the
8999
transport layer state change?  When it's received, or after the ACK is
9000
transmitted.  In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9001
acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9002
to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9003
ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9004
specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9005
that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9006
happened.}
9007
 
9008
@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9009
@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9010
@tab
9011
Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9012
breakpoint at @var{addr}.  @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9013
@samp{z} packets.}
9014
 
9015
@item continue
9016
@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9017
@tab
9018
@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9019
current address.
9020
@item
9021
@tab reply
9022
@tab see below
9023
 
9024
@item continue with signal
9025
@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9026
@tab
9027
Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number).  If
9028
@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9029
@item
9030
@tab reply
9031
@tab see below
9032
 
9033
@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
9034
@tab @code{d}
9035
@tab
9036
toggle debug flag.
9037
 
9038
@item detach
9039
@tab @code{D}
9040
@tab
9041
Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system.  Sent to the remote target before
9042
@value{GDBN} disconnects.
9043
@item
9044
@tab reply @emph{no response}
9045
@tab
9046
@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
9047
 
9048
@item reserved
9049
@tab @code{e}
9050
@tab Reserved for future use
9051
 
9052
@item reserved
9053
@tab @code{E}
9054
@tab Reserved for future use
9055
 
9056
@item reserved
9057
@tab @code{f}
9058
@tab Reserved for future use
9059
 
9060
@item reserved
9061
@tab @code{F}
9062
@tab Reserved for future use
9063
 
9064
@item read registers
9065
@tab @code{g}
9066
@tab Read general registers.
9067
@item
9068
@tab reply @var{XX...}
9069
@tab
9070
Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits.  The bytes
9071
with the register are transmitted in target byte order.  The size of
9072
each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
9073
determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
9074
@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros.  The specification of several standard
9075
@code{g} packets is specified below.
9076
@item
9077
@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9078
@tab for an error.
9079
 
9080
@item write regs
9081
@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9082
@tab
9083
See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9084
@item
9085
@tab reply @code{OK}
9086
@tab for success
9087
@item
9088
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9089
@tab for an error
9090
 
9091
@item reserved
9092
@tab @code{h}
9093
@tab Reserved for future use
9094
 
9095
@item set thread
9096
@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9097
@tab
9098
Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9099
@samp{G}, et.al.).  @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9100
continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads.  @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9101
thread used in other operations.  If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
9102
@item
9103
@tab reply @code{OK}
9104
@tab for success
9105
@item
9106
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9107
@tab for an error
9108
 
9109
@c FIXME: JTC:
9110
@c   'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model.  If a
9111
@c        thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
9112
@c        to continue to execute?  As I mentioned above, I think the
9113
@c        semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9114
@c        described.  For example:
9115
@c
9116
@c        'g':    If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9117
@c                selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9118
@c                otherwise returns current registers.
9119
@c
9120
@c        'G'     If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9121
@c                selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9122
@c                that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9123
 
9124
@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
9125
@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9126
@tab
9127
Step the remote target by a single clock cycle.  If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9128
present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles.  If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9129
step starting at that address.
9130
 
9131
@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
9132
@tab @code{I}
9133
@tab
9134
See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9135
 
9136
@item reserved
9137
@tab @code{j}
9138
@tab Reserved for future use
9139
 
9140
@item reserved
9141
@tab @code{J}
9142
@tab Reserved for future use
9143
 
9144
@item kill request
9145
@tab @code{k}
9146
@tab
9147
FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9148
thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
9149
 
9150
@item reserved
9151
@tab @code{l}
9152
@tab Reserved for future use
9153
 
9154
@item reserved
9155
@tab @code{L}
9156
@tab Reserved for future use
9157
 
9158
@item read memory
9159
@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9160
@tab
9161
Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9162
Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
9163
using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9164
transfer mechanism is needed.}
9165
@item
9166
@tab reply @var{XX...}
9167
@tab
9168
@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
9169
to read only part of the data.  Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
9170
sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9171
@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
9172
@item
9173
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9174
@tab @var{NN} is errno
9175
 
9176
@item write mem
9177
@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
9178
@tab
9179
Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9180
@var{XX...} is the data.
9181
@item
9182
@tab reply @code{OK}
9183
@tab for success
9184
@item
9185
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9186
@tab
9187
for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
9188
written).
9189
 
9190
@item reserved
9191
@tab @code{n}
9192
@tab Reserved for future use
9193
 
9194
@item reserved
9195
@tab @code{N}
9196
@tab Reserved for future use
9197
 
9198
@item reserved
9199
@tab @code{o}
9200
@tab Reserved for future use
9201
 
9202
@item reserved
9203
@tab @code{O}
9204
@tab Reserved for future use
9205
 
9206
@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
9207
@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
9208
@tab
9209
See write register.
9210
@item
9211
@tab return @var{r....}
9212
@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
9213
 
9214
@item write reg
9215
@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
9216
@tab
9217
Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
9218
digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
9219
@item
9220
@tab reply @code{OK}
9221
@tab for success
9222
@item
9223
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9224
@tab for an error
9225
 
9226
@item general query
9227
@tab @code{q}@var{query}
9228
@tab
9229
Request info about @var{query}.  In general @value{GDBN} queries
9230
have a leading upper case letter.  Custom vendor queries should use a
9231
company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}.  @var{query} may
9232
optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list.  Stubs
9233
must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
9234
@item
9235
@tab reply @code{XX...}
9236
@tab Hex encoded data from query.  The reply can not be empty.
9237
@item
9238
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9239
@tab error reply
9240
@item
9241
@tab reply @samp{}
9242
@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9243
 
9244
@item general set
9245
@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9246
@tab
9247
Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.  See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9248
naming conventions.
9249
 
9250
@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
9251
@tab @code{r}
9252
@tab
9253
Reset the entire system.
9254
 
9255
@item remote restart
9256
@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9257
@tab
9258
Restart the remote server.  @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9259
definition.  FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9260
packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
9261
 
9262
@item step
9263
@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9264
@tab
9265
@var{addr} is address to resume.  If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9266
same address.
9267
@item
9268
@tab reply
9269
@tab see below
9270
 
9271
@item step with signal
9272
@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9273
@tab
9274
Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9275
@item
9276
@tab reply
9277
@tab see below
9278
 
9279
@item search
9280
@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9281
@tab
9282
Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9283
@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}.  @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
9284
bytes.  @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
9285
 
9286
@item thread alive
9287
@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9288
@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9289
@item
9290
@tab reply @code{OK}
9291
@tab thread is still alive
9292
@item
9293
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9294
@tab thread is dead
9295
 
9296
@item reserved
9297
@tab @code{u}
9298
@tab Reserved for future use
9299
 
9300
@item reserved
9301
@tab @code{U}
9302
@tab Reserved for future use
9303
 
9304
@item reserved
9305
@tab @code{v}
9306
@tab Reserved for future use
9307
 
9308
@item reserved
9309
@tab @code{V}
9310
@tab Reserved for future use
9311
 
9312
@item reserved
9313
@tab @code{w}
9314
@tab Reserved for future use
9315
 
9316
@item reserved
9317
@tab @code{W}
9318
@tab Reserved for future use
9319
 
9320
@item reserved
9321
@tab @code{x}
9322
@tab Reserved for future use
9323
 
9324
@item write mem (binary)
9325
@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9326
@tab
9327
@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
9328
binary data.  The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9329
escaped using @code{0x7d}.
9330
@item
9331
@tab reply @code{OK}
9332
@tab for success
9333
@item
9334
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9335
@tab for an error
9336
 
9337
@item reserved
9338
@tab @code{y}
9339
@tab Reserved for future use
9340
 
9341
@item reserved
9342
@tab @code{Y}
9343
@tab Reserved for future use
9344
 
9345
@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
9346
@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9347
@tab
9348
See @samp{Z}.
9349
 
9350
@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
9351
@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9352
@tab
9353
@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9354
breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9355
@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9356
bytes.  For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9357
the instruction to be patched.  For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
9358
@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored.  To avoid
9359
potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
9360
implemented in an idempotent way.
9361
@item
9362
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9363
@tab for an error
9364
@item
9365
@tab reply @code{OK}
9366
@tab for success
9367
@item
9368
@tab @samp{}
9369
@tab If not supported.
9370
 
9371
@item reserved
9372
@tab <other>
9373
@tab Reserved for future use
9374
 
9375
@end multitable
9376
 
9377
The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9378
receive any of the below as a reply.  In the case of the @samp{C},
9379
@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9380
when the target halts.  In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9381
number} is poorly defined.  In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9382
conventions is used.
9383
 
9384
@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9385
 
9386
@item @code{S}@var{AA}
9387
@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9388
 
9389
@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9390
@tab
9391
@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9392
(hex), @var{r...}  = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9393
by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9394
thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
9395
starting with valid hex digit.  @value{GDBN} should ignore this
9396
@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next.  This way we can
9397
extend the protocol.
9398
 
9399
@item @code{W}@var{AA}
9400
@tab
9401
The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status.  This is only
9402
applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9403
 
9404
@item @code{X}@var{AA}
9405
@tab
9406
The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9407
 
9408
@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
9409
@tab
9410
@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
9411
@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
9412
@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.  The difference between
9413
this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
9414
spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
9415
debugger.}
9416
 
9417
@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9418
@tab
9419
@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data.  This can happen at any time
9420
while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9421
for 'W', 'T', etc.
9422
 
9423
@end multitable
9424
 
9425
The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9426
 
9427
@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9428
 
9429
@item current thread
9430
@tab @code{q}@code{C}
9431
@tab Return the current thread id.
9432
@item
9433
@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9434
@tab
9435
Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9436
@item
9437
@tab reply *
9438
@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9439
 
9440
@item all thread ids
9441
@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9442
@item
9443
@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
9444
@tab
9445
Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS).  Since there
9446
may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
9447
works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
9448
obtain the entire list of threads.  The first query of the sequence will
9449
be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
9450
sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
9451
@item
9452
@tab
9453
@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
9454
@item
9455
@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
9456
@tab A single thread id
9457
@item
9458
@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
9459
@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
9460
@item
9461
@tab reply @code{l}
9462
@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
9463
@item
9464
@tab
9465
@tab
9466
In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
9467
or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas.  GDB will
9468
respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
9469
@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
9470
(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
9471
 
9472
@item extra thread info
9473
@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
9474
@tab
9475
@item
9476
@tab
9477
@tab
9478
Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
9479
Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
9480
the target OS.  This string may contain anything that the target OS
9481
thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
9482
The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
9483
Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
9484
"Blocked on Mutex".
9485
@item
9486
@tab reply @var{XX...}
9487
@tab
9488
Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
9489
printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
9490
attributes.
9491
 
9492
@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9493
@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9494
@tab
9495
@item
9496
@tab
9497
@tab
9498
Obtain thread information from RTOS.  Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9499
digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9500
subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9501
number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9502
(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9503
returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9504
@item
9505
@tab
9506
@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9507
query (see above).
9508
@item
9509
@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9510
@tab
9511
@item
9512
@tab
9513
@tab
9514
Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9515
returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9516
and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9517
digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9518
a sequence of thread IDs from the target.  @var{threadid} (eight hex
9519
digits).  See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9520
 
9521
@item compute CRC of memory block
9522
@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9523
@tab
9524
@item
9525
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9526
@tab An error (such as memory fault)
9527
@item
9528
@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9529
@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9530
 
9531
@item query sect offs
9532
@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
9533
@tab
9534
Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9535
image.  @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9536
response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9537
offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
9538
@item
9539
@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9540
 
9541
@item thread info request
9542
@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9543
@tab
9544
@item
9545
@tab
9546
@tab
9547
Returns information on @var{threadid}.  Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9548
encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9549
@item
9550
@tab reply *
9551
@tab
9552
See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9553
 
9554
@item remote command
9555
@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9556
@tab
9557
@item
9558
@tab
9559
@tab
9560
@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9561
execution.  Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9562
Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9563
number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9564
packets.  @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9565
stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9566
@item
9567
@tab reply @code{OK}
9568
@tab
9569
A command response with no output.
9570
@item
9571
@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9572
@tab
9573
A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9574
@item
9575
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9576
@tab
9577
Indicate a badly formed request.
9578
 
9579
@item
9580
@tab reply @samp{}
9581
@tab
9582
When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9583
 
9584
@end multitable
9585
 
9586
The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9587
In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9588
bits.  Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9589
space allocated.  Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9590
The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9591
least-significant.
9592
 
9593
@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9594
 
9595
@item MIPS32
9596
@tab
9597
All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
9598
32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9599
registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9600
 
9601
@item MIPS64
9602
@tab
9603
All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9604
thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}).  The ordering is the same
9605
as @code{MIPS32}.
9606
 
9607
@end multitable
9608
 
9609
Example sequence of a target being re-started.  Notice how the restart
9610
does not get any direct output:
9611
 
9612
@example
9613
<- @code{R00}
9614
-> @code{+}
9615
@emph{target restarts}
9616
<- @code{?}
9617
-> @code{+}
9618
-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9619
<- @code{+}
9620
@end example
9621
 
9622
Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9623
 
9624
@example
9625
<- @code{G1445...}
9626
-> @code{+}
9627
<- @code{s}
9628
-> @code{+}
9629
@emph{time passes}
9630
-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9631
<- @code{+}
9632
<- @code{g}
9633
-> @code{+}
9634
-> @code{1455...}
9635
<- @code{+}
9636
@end example
9637
 
9638
@node Server
9639
@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9640
 
9641
@kindex gdbserver
9642
@cindex remote connection without stubs
9643
@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9644
allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9645
@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9646
 
9647
@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9648
because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9649
that @value{GDBN} itself does.  In fact, a system that can run
9650
@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9651
@value{GDBN} locally!  @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9652
because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself.  It is
9653
also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9654
started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9655
Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9656
the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9657
do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9658
by cross-compiling.  You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9659
choice for debugging.
9660
 
9661
@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9662
or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9663
protocol.
9664
 
9665
@table @emph
9666
@item On the target machine,
9667
you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9668
@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9669
strip the program if necessary to save space.  @value{GDBN} on the host
9670
system does all the symbol handling.
9671
 
9672
To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9673
the name of your program; and the arguments for your program.  The
9674
syntax is:
9675
 
9676
@smallexample
9677
target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9678
@end smallexample
9679
 
9680
@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9681
hostname and portnumber.  For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9682
@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9683
@file{/dev/com1}:
9684
 
9685
@smallexample
9686
target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9687
@end smallexample
9688
 
9689
@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9690
with it.
9691
 
9692
To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9693
 
9694
@smallexample
9695
target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9696
@end smallexample
9697
 
9698
The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9699
specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9700
TCP.  The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9701
expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9702
(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.)  You can choose any number
9703
you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9704
TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9705
reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9706
conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
9707
and exits.}  You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
9708
@code{target remote} command.
9709
 
9710
@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9711
you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9712
symbols and debugging information.  Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9713
using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9714
(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
9715
running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.)  After that, use @code{target
9716
remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}.  Its argument
9717
is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9718
@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9719
@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}.  For example:
9720
 
9721
@smallexample
9722
(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9723
@end smallexample
9724
 
9725
@noindent
9726
communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9727
 
9728
@smallexample
9729
(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9730
@end smallexample
9731
 
9732
@noindent
9733
communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9734
For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9735
the @code{target remote} command.  Otherwise you may get an error whose
9736
text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9737
@samp{Connection refused}.
9738
@end table
9739
 
9740
@node NetWare
9741
@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9742
 
9743
@kindex gdbserve.nlm
9744
@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9745
allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9746
@code{target remote}.
9747
 
9748
@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9749
using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9750
 
9751
@table @emph
9752
@item On the target machine,
9753
you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9754
@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9755
can strip the program if necessary to save space.  @value{GDBN} on the
9756
host system does all the symbol handling.
9757
 
9758
To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9759
@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9760
program.  The syntax is:
9761
 
9762
@smallexample
9763
load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9764
              [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9765
@end smallexample
9766
 
9767
@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9768
the baud rate used by the connection.  @var{port} and @var{node} default
9769
to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
9770
 
9771
For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
9772
communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
9773
using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
9774
 
9775
@smallexample
9776
load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9777
@end smallexample
9778
 
9779
@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9780
you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9781
symbols and debugging information.  Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9782
using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9783
(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
9784
running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.  After that, use @code{target
9785
remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}.  Its
9786
argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9787
@file{/dev/ttyb}).  For example:
9788
 
9789
@smallexample
9790
(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9791
@end smallexample
9792
 
9793
@noindent
9794
communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9795
@end table
9796
 
9797
@node KOD
9798
@section Kernel Object Display
9799
 
9800
@cindex kernel object display
9801
@cindex kernel object
9802
@cindex KOD
9803
 
9804
Some targets support kernel object display.  Using this facility,
9805
@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9806
and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9807
mutexes and other synchronization objects.  Exactly which objects can be
9808
displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9809
 
9810
Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system.  This tells
9811
@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9812
 
9813
@example
9814
(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
9815
@end example
9816
 
9817
If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9818
about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9819
which can be used to query the target.  The @code{info} command is named
9820
after the operating system:
9821
 
9822
@example
9823
(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
9824
List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9825
Object     Description
9826
any        Any and all objects
9827
@end example
9828
 
9829
Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9830
by the kernel.
9831
 
9832
There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
9833
is supported other than to try it.
9834
 
9835
 
9836
@node Configurations
9837
@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9838
 
9839
While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9840
cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions.  This chapter
9841
describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9842
 
9843
There are three major categories of configurations: native
9844
configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9845
operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9846
different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9847
are quite different from each other.
9848
 
9849
@menu
9850
* Native::
9851
* Embedded OS::
9852
* Embedded Processors::
9853
* Architectures::
9854
@end menu
9855
 
9856
@node Native
9857
@section Native
9858
 
9859
This section describes details specific to particular native
9860
configurations.
9861
 
9862
@menu
9863
* HP-UX::                       HP-UX
9864
* SVR4 Process Information::    SVR4 process information
9865
@end menu
9866
 
9867
@node HP-UX
9868
@subsection HP-UX
9869
 
9870
On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9871
begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9872
name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9873
 
9874
@node SVR4 Process Information
9875
@subsection SVR4 process information
9876
 
9877
@kindex /proc
9878
@cindex process image
9879
 
9880
Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
9881
used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
9882
subroutines.  If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
9883
this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
9884
several kinds of information about the process running your program.
9885
@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
9886
@code{procfs} code.  This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
9887
and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
9888
 
9889
@table @code
9890
@kindex info proc
9891
@item info proc
9892
Summarize available information about the process.
9893
 
9894
@kindex info proc mappings
9895
@item info proc mappings
9896
Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
9897
on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
9898
 
9899
@kindex info proc times
9900
@item info proc times
9901
Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
9902
its children.
9903
 
9904
@kindex info proc id
9905
@item info proc id
9906
Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
9907
the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
9908
 
9909
@kindex info proc status
9910
@item info proc status
9911
General information on the state of the process.  If the process is
9912
stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
9913
received.
9914
 
9915
@item info proc all
9916
Show all the above information about the process.
9917
@end table
9918
 
9919
@node Embedded OS
9920
@section Embedded Operating Systems
9921
 
9922
This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
9923
embedded operating systems that are available for several different
9924
architectures.
9925
 
9926
@menu
9927
* VxWorks::                     Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9928
@end menu
9929
 
9930
@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
9931
various real-time operating systems.
9932
 
9933
@node VxWorks
9934
@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9935
 
9936
@cindex VxWorks
9937
 
9938
@table @code
9939
 
9940
@kindex target vxworks
9941
@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
9942
A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP.  The argument @var{machinename}
9943
is the target system's machine name or IP address.
9944
 
9945
@end table
9946
 
9947
On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
9948
current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
9949
 
9950
@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
9951
VxWorks targets from a Unix host.  Already-running tasks spawned from
9952
the VxWorks shell can also be debugged.  @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
9953
both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target.  The program
9954
@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.  (It may be
9955
installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
9956
@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
9957
 
9958
@table @code
9959
@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
9960
@kindex vxworks-timeout
9961
All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
9962
This option is set by the user, and  @var{args} represents the number of
9963
seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's.  You might use this if
9964
your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
9965
of a thin network line.
9966
@end table
9967
 
9968
The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
9969
this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
9970
procedures.
9971
 
9972
@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
9973
To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
9974
to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
9975
library @file{rdb.a}.  To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
9976
VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
9977
kernel.  The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
9978
source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted.  For more
9979
information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
9980
manual.
9981
@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
9982
 
9983
Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
9984
your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
9985
run @value{GDBN}.  From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
9986
@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
9987
 
9988
@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
9989
 
9990
@example
9991
(vxgdb)
9992
@end example
9993
 
9994
@menu
9995
* VxWorks Connection::          Connecting to VxWorks
9996
* VxWorks Download::            VxWorks download
9997
* VxWorks Attach::              Running tasks
9998
@end menu
9999
 
10000
@node VxWorks Connection
10001
@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10002
 
10003
The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10004
network.  To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10005
 
10006
@example
10007
(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10008
@end example
10009
 
10010
@need 750
10011
@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10012
 
10013
@smallexample
10014
Attaching remote machine across net...
10015
Connected to tt.
10016
@end smallexample
10017
 
10018
@need 1000
10019
@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10020
loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted.  @value{GDBN} locates
10021
these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10022
path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10023
to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10024
 
10025
@example
10026
prog.o: No such file or directory.
10027
@end example
10028
 
10029
When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10030
the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10031
command again.
10032
 
10033
@node VxWorks Download
10034
@subsubsection VxWorks download
10035
 
10036
@cindex download to VxWorks
10037
If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10038
object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10039
@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10040
incrementally.  The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10041
command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10042
to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10043
table.  This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10044
the two systems differ.  If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10045
filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10046
Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10047
to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10048
the file by its name, without any path.  For instance, a program
10049
@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10050
and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host.  To load this
10051
program, type this on VxWorks:
10052
 
10053
@example
10054
-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10055
@end example
10056
 
10057
@noindent
10058
Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10059
 
10060
@example
10061
(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
10062
(vxgdb) load prog.o
10063
@end example
10064
 
10065
@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10066
 
10067
@smallexample
10068
Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10069
@end smallexample
10070
 
10071
You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10072
after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file.  Note that
10073
this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10074
auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10075
history.  (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
10076
debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
10077
table.)
10078
 
10079
@node VxWorks Attach
10080
@subsubsection Running tasks
10081
 
10082
@cindex running VxWorks tasks
10083
You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10084
follows:
10085
 
10086
@example
10087
(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10088
@end example
10089
 
10090
@noindent
10091
where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID.  The task can be running
10092
or suspended when you attach to it.  Running tasks are suspended at
10093
the time of attachment.
10094
 
10095
@node Embedded Processors
10096
@section Embedded Processors
10097
 
10098
This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10099
configurations.
10100
 
10101
@menu
10102
* A29K Embedded::               AMD A29K Embedded
10103
* ARM::                         ARM
10104
* H8/300::                      Hitachi H8/300
10105
* H8/500::                      Hitachi H8/500
10106
* i960::                        Intel i960
10107
* M32R/D::                      Mitsubishi M32R/D
10108
* M68K::                        Motorola M68K
10109
* M88K::                        Motorola M88K
10110
* MIPS Embedded::               MIPS Embedded
10111
* PA::                          HP PA Embedded
10112
* PowerPC:                      PowerPC
10113
* SH::                          Hitachi SH
10114
* Sparclet::                    Tsqware Sparclet
10115
* Sparclite::                   Fujitsu Sparclite
10116
* ST2000::                      Tandem ST2000
10117
* Z8000::                       Zilog Z8000
10118
@end menu
10119
 
10120
@node A29K Embedded
10121
@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10122
 
10123
@menu
10124
* A29K UDI::
10125
* A29K EB29K::
10126
* Comms (EB29K)::               Communications setup
10127
* gdb-EB29K::                   EB29K cross-debugging
10128
* Remote Log::                  Remote log
10129
@end menu
10130
 
10131
@table @code
10132
 
10133
@kindex target adapt
10134
@item target adapt @var{dev}
10135
Adapt monitor for A29K.
10136
 
10137
@kindex target amd-eb
10138
@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10139
@cindex AMD EB29K
10140
Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10141
@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10142
@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10143
name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10144
@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10145
 
10146
@end table
10147
 
10148
@node A29K UDI
10149
@subsubsection A29K UDI
10150
 
10151
@cindex UDI
10152
@cindex AMD29K via UDI
10153
 
10154
@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10155
protocol for debugging the a29k processor family.  To use this
10156
configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10157
program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge.  You can also
10158
use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10159
@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10160
 
10161
@table @code
10162
@item target udi @var{keyword}
10163
@kindex udi
10164
Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10165
@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10166
This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10167
connect to a29k targets.  If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10168
working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10169
to its pathname.
10170
@end table
10171
 
10172
@node A29K EB29K
10173
@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10174
 
10175
@cindex EB29K board
10176
@cindex running 29K programs
10177
 
10178
AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10179
with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}.  As a shorthand
10180
term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''.  To use
10181
@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10182
must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10183
board) and a serial port on the Unix system.  In the following, we
10184
assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10185
@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10186
 
10187
@node Comms (EB29K)
10188
@subsubsection Communications setup
10189
 
10190
The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
10191
in DOS on the PC:
10192
 
10193
@example
10194
C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
10195
@end example
10196
 
10197
@noindent
10198
This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
10199
bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
10200
you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
10201
end of the connection as well.
10202
@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
10203
@c       mean?  It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10204
@c
10205
@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
10206
@c default value set when the DOS machines boots?  "No retry" means that
10207
@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
10208
@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
10209
@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
10210
 
10211
To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
10212
the following at the DOS console:
10213
 
10214
@example
10215
C:\> CTTY com1
10216
@end example
10217
 
10218
@noindent
10219
(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
10220
the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
10221
had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
10222
 
10223
From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
10224
@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
10225
 
10226
@example
10227
cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
10228
@end example
10229
 
10230
@noindent
10231
The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
10232
serial port to use.  If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
10233
may look something like the following:
10234
 
10235
@example
10236
tip -9600 /dev/ttya
10237
@end example
10238
 
10239
@noindent
10240
Your system may require a different name where we show
10241
@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}.  The communications
10242
parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
10243
@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
10244
system table @file{/etc/remote}.
10245
@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
10246
@c the DOS side's comms setup?  cu can support -o (odd
10247
@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
10248
@c for character size.  Taken from stty maybe...?  John points out tip
10249
@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
10250
@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
10251
@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10252
@c
10253
@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
10254
@c command.  The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
10255
@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
10256
 
10257
@kindex EBMON
10258
Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
10259
directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
10260
start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
10261
with your board by AMD).  You should see an initial display from
10262
@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
10263
@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
10264
 
10265
@example
10266
C:\> G:
10267
 
10268
G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
10269
 
10270
G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
10271
Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
10272
Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
10273
Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
10274
 
10275
Enter '?' or 'H' for help
10276
 
10277
PC Coprocessor Type   = EB29K
10278
I/O Base              = 0x208
10279
Memory Base           = 0xd0000
10280
 
10281
Data Memory Size      = 2048KB
10282
Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
10283
Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
10284
 
10285
PageSize              = 0x400
10286
Register Stack Size   = 0x800
10287
Memory Stack Size     = 0x1800
10288
 
10289
CPU PRL               = 0x3
10290
Am29027 Available     = No
10291
Byte Write Available  = Yes
10292
 
10293
# ~.
10294
@end example
10295
 
10296
Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
10297
typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt).  @code{EBMON} keeps
10298
running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10299
 
10300
For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10301
way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
10302
system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
10303
PC as a file system on the Unix host.  If you do not have PC/NFS or
10304
something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10305
other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10306
from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10307
serial line.
10308
 
10309
@node gdb-EB29K
10310
@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10311
 
10312
Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10313
program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10314
name of your 29K program:
10315
 
10316
@example
10317
cd /usr/joe/work29k
10318
@value{GDBP} myfoo
10319
@end example
10320
 
10321
@need 500
10322
Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10323
 
10324
@example
10325
target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10326
@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps!  caps are meant to
10327
@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10328
@c single-minded about case of letters).  ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10329
@end example
10330
 
10331
@noindent
10332
In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10333
@file{myfoo}.  Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10334
@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10335
In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10336
a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10337
the name on the Unix side.
10338
 
10339
At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10340
to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10341
@code{run}.
10342
 
10343
To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10344
command.
10345
 
10346
To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10347
once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10348
@code{EBMON}.  You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10349
@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
10350
Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
10351
and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10352
 
10353
@node Remote Log
10354
@subsubsection Remote log
10355
@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
10356
@cindex log file for EB29K
10357
 
10358
The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10359
current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10360
@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10361
of the commands sent to it.  Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10362
another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10363
unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10364
 
10365
@node ARM
10366
@subsection ARM
10367
 
10368
@table @code
10369
 
10370
@kindex target rdi
10371
@item target rdi @var{dev}
10372
ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol.  You may
10373
use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10374
monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
10375
 
10376
@kindex target rdp
10377
@item target rdp @var{dev}
10378
ARM Demon monitor.
10379
 
10380
@end table
10381
 
10382
@node H8/300
10383
@subsection Hitachi H8/300
10384
 
10385
@table @code
10386
 
10387
@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
10388
@item target hms @var{dev}
10389
A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10390
Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10391
line and the communications speed used.
10392
 
10393
@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
10394
@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10395
E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10396
 
10397
@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10398
@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
10399
@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10400
@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
10401
Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10402
 
10403
@end table
10404
 
10405
@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10406
@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10407
@cindex download to Hitachi SH
10408
@cindex Hitachi SH download
10409
When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10410
board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10411
board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10412
@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10413
 
10414
@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
10415
Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
10416
 
10417
@enumerate
10418
@item
10419
that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10420
for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10421
emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H.  (@samp{target hms} is
10422
the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
10423
H8/300, or H8/500.)
10424
 
10425
@item
10426
what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10427
serial device available on your host is the default).
10428
 
10429
@item
10430
what speed to use over the serial device.
10431
@end enumerate
10432
 
10433
@menu
10434
* Hitachi Boards::      Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10435
* Hitachi ICE::         Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10436
* Hitachi Special::     Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10437
@end menu
10438
 
10439
@node Hitachi Boards
10440
@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10441
 
10442
@c only for Unix hosts
10443
@kindex device
10444
@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
10445
Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
10446
need to explicitly set the serial device.  The default @var{port} is the
10447
first available port on your host.  This is only necessary on Unix
10448
hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10449
 
10450
@kindex speed
10451
@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
10452
@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
10453
speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}.  This command also is only used from Unix
10454
hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
10455
the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10456
@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
10457
 
10458
The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10459
use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs.  If you
10460
use a DOS host,
10461
@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10462
called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10463
through a PC serial port.  You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10464
to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10465
 
10466
The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10467
program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300.  The example uses a
10468
sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}.  The procedure is the same for
10469
the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10470
 
10471
First hook up your development board.  In this example, we use a
10472
board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10473
port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10474
When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
10475
debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
10476
for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10477
@code{COM2}.
10478
 
10479
@example
10480
C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10481
C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10482
 
10483
Resident portion of MODE loaded
10484
 
10485
COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10486
 
10487
@end example
10488
 
10489
@quotation
10490
@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10491
@code{asynctsr}.  If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10492
disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10493
your development board.
10494
@end quotation
10495
 
10496
@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
10497
Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10498
connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}.  Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
10499
the name of your program as the argument.  @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
10500
you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.  Use two special
10501
commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10502
cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10503
download your program to the board.  @code{load} displays the names of
10504
the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10505
(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10506
executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10507
@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}.  These commands, and @code{load}
10508
itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10509
 
10510
@smallexample
10511
(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
10512
@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
10513
 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
10514
 the conditions.
10515
There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
10516
for details.
10517
@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10518
(@value{GDBP}) target hms
10519
Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
10520
(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
10521
.text   : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10522
.data   : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10523
.stack  : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10524
@end smallexample
10525
 
10526
At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program.  From here on,
10527
you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.  The @code{break} command
10528
sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10529
@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10530
resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint.  You can use the
10531
@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10532
 
10533
Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10534
available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10535
you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10536
 
10537
Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10538
@itemize @bullet
10539
@item
10540
to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10541
no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10542
 
10543
@item
10544
to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10545
normally.  The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10546
to detect program completion.
10547
@end itemize
10548
 
10549
In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10550
development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10551
 
10552
@node Hitachi ICE
10553
@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10554
 
10555
@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
10556
You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10557
Hitachi SH or the H8/300H.  Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10558
e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10559
 
10560
@table @code
10561
@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10562
Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port.  The
10563
@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10564
@samp{com2}).  The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10565
(for example, @samp{9600}).
10566
 
10567
@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10568
If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10569
specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10570
@end table
10571
 
10572
@node Hitachi Special
10573
@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10574
 
10575
Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10576
 
10577
@table @code
10578
 
10579
@kindex set machine
10580
@kindex show machine
10581
@item set machine h8300
10582
@itemx set machine h8300h
10583
Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10584
architecture with @samp{set machine}.  You can use @samp{show machine}
10585
to check which variant is currently in effect.
10586
 
10587
@end table
10588
 
10589
@node H8/500
10590
@subsection H8/500
10591
 
10592
@table @code
10593
 
10594
@kindex set memory @var{mod}
10595
@cindex memory models, H8/500
10596
@item set memory @var{mod}
10597
@itemx show memory
10598
Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10599
@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10600
memory}.  The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10601
@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10602
 
10603
@end table
10604
 
10605
@node i960
10606
@subsection Intel i960
10607
 
10608
@table @code
10609
 
10610
@kindex target mon960
10611
@item target mon960 @var{dev}
10612
MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10613
 
10614
@kindex target nindy
10615
@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10616
An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor.  @var{devicename} is
10617
the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10618
@file{/dev/ttya}.
10619
 
10620
@end table
10621
 
10622
@cindex Nindy
10623
@cindex i960
10624
@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems.  When
10625
@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10626
tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10627
 
10628
@itemize @bullet
10629
@item
10630
Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10631
Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10632
 
10633
@item
10634
By responding to a prompt on startup;
10635
 
10636
@item
10637
By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10638
session.  @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10639
 
10640
@end itemize
10641
 
10642
@cindex download to Nindy-960
10643
With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10644
downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10645
@value{GDBN}.
10646
 
10647
@menu
10648
* Nindy Startup::               Startup with Nindy
10649
* Nindy Options::               Options for Nindy
10650
* Nindy Reset::                 Nindy reset command
10651
@end menu
10652
 
10653
@node Nindy Startup
10654
@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10655
 
10656
If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10657
options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10658
reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10659
 
10660
@example
10661
Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
10662
@end example
10663
 
10664
@noindent
10665
Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10666
identifies the serial port you want to use.  You can, if you choose,
10667
simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10668
with an empty line.  If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10669
use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10670
 
10671
@node Nindy Options
10672
@subsubsection Options for Nindy
10673
 
10674
These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10675
Nindy-960 board attached:
10676
 
10677
@table @code
10678
@item -r @var{port}
10679
Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10680
to the target system.  This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10681
configured for the Intel 960 target architecture.  You may specify
10682
@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10683
device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10684
suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10685
 
10686
@item -O
10687
(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.)  Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10688
the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10689
This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10690
target architecture.
10691
 
10692
@quotation
10693
@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10694
connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10695
fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch.  @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10696
attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds.  You can abort
10697
this process with an interrupt.
10698
@end quotation
10699
 
10700
@item -brk
10701
Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10702
system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10703
 
10704
@quotation
10705
@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10706
requires; it only works with a few boards.
10707
@end quotation
10708
@end table
10709
 
10710
The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10711
port.
10712
 
10713
@c @group
10714
@node Nindy Reset
10715
@subsubsection Nindy reset command
10716
 
10717
@table @code
10718
@item reset
10719
@kindex reset
10720
For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10721
system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10722
circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10723
a break is detected.
10724
@end table
10725
@c @end group
10726
 
10727
@node M32R/D
10728
@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10729
 
10730
@table @code
10731
 
10732
@kindex target m32r
10733
@item target m32r @var{dev}
10734
Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10735
 
10736
@end table
10737
 
10738
@node M68K
10739
@subsection M68k
10740
 
10741
The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10742
target command for the following ROM monitors.
10743
 
10744
@table @code
10745
 
10746
@kindex target abug
10747
@item target abug @var{dev}
10748
ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10749
 
10750
@kindex target cpu32bug
10751
@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10752
CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10753
 
10754
@kindex target dbug
10755
@item target dbug @var{dev}
10756
dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10757
 
10758
@kindex target est
10759
@item target est @var{dev}
10760
EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10761
 
10762
@kindex target rom68k
10763
@item target rom68k @var{dev}
10764
ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10765
 
10766
@end table
10767
 
10768
If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10769
instead have only a single special target command:
10770
 
10771
@table @code
10772
 
10773
@kindex target es1800
10774
@item target es1800 @var{dev}
10775
ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10776
 
10777
@end table
10778
 
10779
[context?]
10780
 
10781
@table @code
10782
 
10783
@kindex target rombug
10784
@item target rombug @var{dev}
10785
ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10786
 
10787
@end table
10788
 
10789
@node M88K
10790
@subsection M88K
10791
 
10792
@table @code
10793
 
10794
@kindex target bug
10795
@item target bug @var{dev}
10796
BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10797
 
10798
@end table
10799
 
10800
@node MIPS Embedded
10801
@subsection MIPS Embedded
10802
 
10803
@cindex MIPS boards
10804
@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10805
MIPS board attached to a serial line.  This is available when
10806
you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10807
 
10808
@need 1000
10809
Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10810
 
10811
@table @code
10812
@item target mips @var{port}
10813
@kindex target mips @var{port}
10814
To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10815
name of your program as the argument.  To connect to the board, use the
10816
command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10817
the serial port connected to the board.  If the program has not already
10818
been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10819
download it.  You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10820
 
10821
For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10822
port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10823
debugger:
10824
 
10825
@example
10826
host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
10827
@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10828
(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10829
(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10830
(@value{GDBP}) run
10831
@end example
10832
 
10833
@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10834
On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10835
connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10836
concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10837
@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10838
 
10839
@item target pmon @var{port}
10840
@kindex target pmon @var{port}
10841
PMON ROM monitor.
10842
 
10843
@item target ddb @var{port}
10844
@kindex target ddb @var{port}
10845
NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10846
 
10847
@item target lsi @var{port}
10848
@kindex target lsi @var{port}
10849
LSI variant of PMON.
10850
 
10851
@kindex target r3900
10852
@item target r3900 @var{dev}
10853
Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
10854
 
10855
@kindex target array
10856
@item target array @var{dev}
10857
Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
10858
 
10859
@end table
10860
 
10861
 
10862
@noindent
10863
@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
10864
 
10865
@table @code
10866
@item set processor @var{args}
10867
@itemx show processor
10868
@kindex set processor @var{args}
10869
@kindex show processor
10870
Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
10871
processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
10872
For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
10873
to use the CPO registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
10874
Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
10875
is using.  Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
10876
@value{GDBN} is using.
10877
 
10878
@item set mipsfpu double
10879
@itemx set mipsfpu single
10880
@itemx set mipsfpu none
10881
@itemx show mipsfpu
10882
@kindex set mipsfpu
10883
@kindex show mipsfpu
10884
@cindex MIPS remote floating point
10885
@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
10886
If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
10887
coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
10888
need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
10889
file).  This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
10890
functions which return floating point values.  It also allows
10891
@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
10892
functions on the board.  If you are using a floating point coprocessor
10893
with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
10894
processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}.  The default
10895
double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
10896
@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
10897
 
10898
In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
10899
floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
10900
and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
10901
 
10902
As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
10903
@samp{show mipsfpu}.
10904
 
10905
@item set remotedebug @var{n}
10906
@itemx show remotedebug
10907
@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10908
@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10909
@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
10910
@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
10911
@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
10912
@c FIXME...protocol.  Where is it described?
10913
You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
10914
by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable.  If you set it to @code{1} using
10915
@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed.  If you set it
10916
to @code{2}, every character is displayed.  You can check the current value
10917
at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
10918
 
10919
@item set timeout @var{seconds}
10920
@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
10921
@itemx show timeout
10922
@itemx show retransmit-timeout
10923
@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
10924
@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
10925
@kindex set timeout
10926
@kindex show timeout
10927
@kindex set retransmit-timeout
10928
@kindex show retransmit-timeout
10929
You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
10930
remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command.  The
10931
default is 5 seconds.  Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
10932
waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
10933
retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command.  The default is 3 seconds.
10934
You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
10935
retransmit-timeout}.  (These commands are @emph{only} available when
10936
@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
10937
 
10938
The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
10939
is waiting for your program to stop.  In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
10940
forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
10941
to run before stopping.
10942
@end table
10943
 
10944
@node PowerPC
10945
@subsection PowerPC
10946
 
10947
@table @code
10948
 
10949
@kindex target dink32
10950
@item target dink32 @var{dev}
10951
DINK32 ROM monitor.
10952
 
10953
@kindex target ppcbug
10954
@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
10955
@kindex target ppcbug1
10956
@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
10957
PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
10958
 
10959
@kindex target sds
10960
@item target sds @var{dev}
10961
SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
10962
 
10963
@end table
10964
 
10965
@node PA
10966
@subsection HP PA Embedded
10967
 
10968
@table @code
10969
 
10970
@kindex target op50n
10971
@item target op50n @var{dev}
10972
OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
10973
 
10974
@kindex target w89k
10975
@item target w89k @var{dev}
10976
W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
10977
 
10978
@end table
10979
 
10980
@node SH
10981
@subsection Hitachi SH
10982
 
10983
@table @code
10984
 
10985
@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
10986
@item target hms @var{dev}
10987
A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host.  Use special
10988
commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
10989
the communications speed used.
10990
 
10991
@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
10992
@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10993
E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
10994
 
10995
@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
10996
@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
10997
@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10998
@item target sh3e @var{dev}
10999
Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11000
 
11001
@end table
11002
 
11003
@node Sparclet
11004
@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11005
 
11006
@cindex Sparclet
11007
 
11008
@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11009
Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11010
@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11011
both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target.  The program
11012
@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
11013
 
11014
@table @code
11015
@item remotetimeout @var{args}
11016
@kindex remotetimeout
11017
@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11018
This option is set by the user, and  @var{args} represents the number of
11019
seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
11020
@end table
11021
 
11022
@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11023
When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11024
information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11025
load it on the target.  You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11026
@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections.  Example:
11027
 
11028
@example
11029
sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11030
@end example
11031
 
11032
You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
11033
 
11034
@example
11035
sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11036
@end example
11037
 
11038
@cindex running, on Sparclet
11039
Once you have set
11040
your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11041
run @value{GDBN}.  From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11042
(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11043
 
11044
@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11045
 
11046
@example
11047
(gdbslet)
11048
@end example
11049
 
11050
@menu
11051
* Sparclet File::                Setting the file to debug
11052
* Sparclet Connection::          Connecting to Sparclet
11053
* Sparclet Download::            Sparclet download
11054
* Sparclet Execution::           Running and debugging
11055
@end menu
11056
 
11057
@node Sparclet File
11058
@subsubsection Setting file to debug
11059
 
11060
The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11061
 
11062
@example
11063
(gdbslet) file prog
11064
@end example
11065
 
11066
@need 1000
11067
@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11068
@value{GDBN} locates
11069
the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11070
path.
11071
If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11072
files will be searched as well.
11073
@value{GDBN} locates
11074
the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11075
path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11076
If it fails
11077
to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11078
 
11079
@example
11080
prog: No such file or directory.
11081
@end example
11082
 
11083
When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
11084
the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
11085
@code{target} command again.
11086
 
11087
@node Sparclet Connection
11088
@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11089
 
11090
The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11091
To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11092
 
11093
@example
11094
(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11095
Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
11096
main () at ../prog.c:3
11097
@end example
11098
 
11099
@need 750
11100
@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11101
 
11102
@example
11103
Connected to ttya.
11104
@end example
11105
 
11106
@node Sparclet Download
11107
@subsubsection Sparclet download
11108
 
11109
@cindex download to Sparclet
11110
Once connected to the Sparclet target,
11111
you can use the @value{GDBN}
11112
@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11113
The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11114
command.
11115
Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
11116
address.  You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is.  The load
11117
offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11118
of each of the file's sections.
11119
For instance, if the program
11120
@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11121
and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11122
 
11123
@example
11124
(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11125
Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11126
@end example
11127
 
11128
If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11129
to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
11130
to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11131
 
11132
@node Sparclet Execution
11133
@subsubsection Running and debugging
11134
 
11135
@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11136
You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
11137
commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc.  See the @value{GDBN}
11138
manual for the list of commands.
11139
 
11140
@example
11141
(gdbslet) b main
11142
Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
11143
(gdbslet) run
11144
Starting program: prog
11145
Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
11146
3        char *symarg = 0;
11147
(gdbslet) step
11148
4        char *execarg = "hello!";
11149
(gdbslet)
11150
@end example
11151
 
11152
@node Sparclite
11153
@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
11154
 
11155
@table @code
11156
 
11157
@kindex target sparclite
11158
@item target sparclite @var{dev}
11159
Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11160
You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11161
For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
11162
remote protocol.
11163
 
11164
@end table
11165
 
11166
@node ST2000
11167
@subsection Tandem ST2000
11168
 
11169
@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
11170
STDBUG protocol.
11171
 
11172
To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11173
manual.  Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11174
 
11175
@example
11176
target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11177
@end example
11178
 
11179
@noindent
11180
to establish it as your debugging environment.  @var{dev} is normally
11181
the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11182
ST2000 via a serial line.  You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11183
connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11184
concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11185
 
11186
The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11187
this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11188
would for standalone operation.  @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11189
(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11190
available on your host computer.
11191
@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11192
@c basically hearsay.
11193
 
11194
@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11195
These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11196
environment:
11197
 
11198
@table @code
11199
@item st2000 @var{command}
11200
@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11201
@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11202
@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11203
Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor.  See the manufacturer's
11204
manual for available commands.
11205
 
11206
@item connect
11207
@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11208
Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor.  When
11209
you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11210
sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11211
@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11212
@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
11213
@end table
11214
 
11215
@node Z8000
11216
@subsection Zilog Z8000
11217
 
11218
@cindex Z8000
11219
@cindex simulator, Z8000
11220
@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
11221
 
11222
When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11223
a Z8000 simulator.
11224
 
11225
For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11226
unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11227
segmented variant).  The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11228
appropriate by inspecting the object code.
11229
 
11230
@table @code
11231
@item target sim @var{args}
11232
@kindex sim
11233
@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
11234
Debug programs on a simulated CPU.  If the simulator supports setup
11235
options, specify them via @var{args}.
11236
@end table
11237
 
11238
@noindent
11239
After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
11240
CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
11241
@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
11242
to run your program, and so on.
11243
 
11244
As well as making available all the usual machine registers
11245
(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
11246
additional items of information as specially named registers:
11247
 
11248
@table @code
11249
 
11250
@item cycles
11251
Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
11252
 
11253
@item insts
11254
Counts instructions run in the simulator.
11255
 
11256
@item time
11257
Execution time in 60ths of a second.
11258
 
11259
@end table
11260
 
11261
You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
11262
conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
11263
conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
11264
simulated clock ticks.
11265
 
11266
@node Architectures
11267
@section Architectures
11268
 
11269
This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
11270
all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
11271
 
11272
@menu
11273
* A29K::
11274
* Alpha::
11275
* MIPS::
11276
@end menu
11277
 
11278
@node A29K
11279
@subsection A29K
11280
 
11281
@table @code
11282
 
11283
@kindex set rstack_high_address
11284
@cindex AMD 29K register stack
11285
@cindex register stack, AMD29K
11286
@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
11287
On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
11288
@dfn{register stack}.  There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
11289
extent of this stack.  Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11290
stack is ``large enough''.  This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11291
memory locations that do not exist.  If necessary, you can get around
11292
this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11293
the @code{set rstack_high_address} command.  The argument should be an
11294
address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11295
hexadecimal.
11296
 
11297
@kindex show rstack_high_address
11298
@item show rstack_high_address
11299
Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11300
processors.
11301
 
11302
@end table
11303
 
11304
@node Alpha
11305
@subsection Alpha
11306
 
11307
See the following section.
11308
 
11309
@node MIPS
11310
@subsection MIPS
11311
 
11312
@cindex stack on Alpha
11313
@cindex stack on MIPS
11314
@cindex Alpha stack
11315
@cindex MIPS stack
11316
Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11317
sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11318
find the beginning of a function.
11319
 
11320
@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11321
To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11322
@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11323
you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11324
commands:
11325
 
11326
@table @code
11327
@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
11328
@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11329
Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11330
search for the beginning of a function.  A value of @var{0} (the
11331
default) means there is no limit.  However, except for @var{0}, the
11332
larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11333
and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11334
 
11335
@item show heuristic-fence-post
11336
Display the current limit.
11337
@end table
11338
 
11339
@noindent
11340
These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11341
for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11342
 
11343
 
11344
@node Controlling GDB
11345
@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11346
 
11347
You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11348
@code{set} command.  For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
11349
data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.  Other settings are
11350
described here.
11351
 
11352
@menu
11353
* Prompt::                      Prompt
11354
* Editing::                     Command editing
11355
* History::                     Command history
11356
* Screen Size::                 Screen size
11357
* Numbers::                     Numbers
11358
* Messages/Warnings::           Optional warnings and messages
11359
* Debugging Output::            Optional messages about internal happenings
11360
@end menu
11361
 
11362
@node Prompt
11363
@section Prompt
11364
 
11365
@cindex prompt
11366
 
11367
@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11368
called the @dfn{prompt}.  This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.  You
11369
can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command.  For
11370
instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
11371
the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
11372
which one you are talking to.
11373
 
11374
@emph{Note:}  @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
11375
prompt you set.  This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11376
or a prompt that does not.
11377
 
11378
@table @code
11379
@kindex set prompt
11380
@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11381
Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11382
 
11383
@kindex show prompt
11384
@item show prompt
11385
Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11386
@end table
11387
 
11388
@node Editing
11389
@section Command editing
11390
@cindex readline
11391
@cindex command line editing
11392
 
11393
@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface.  This
11394
@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11395
command line interface to the user.  Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11396
or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11397
substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11398
debugging sessions.
11399
 
11400
You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11401
command @code{set}.
11402
 
11403
@table @code
11404
@kindex set editing
11405
@cindex editing
11406
@item set editing
11407
@itemx set editing on
11408
Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11409
 
11410
@item set editing off
11411
Disable command line editing.
11412
 
11413
@kindex show editing
11414
@item show editing
11415
Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11416
@end table
11417
 
11418
@node History
11419
@section Command history
11420
 
11421
@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11422
debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11423
happened.  Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11424
history facility.
11425
 
11426
@table @code
11427
@cindex history substitution
11428
@cindex history file
11429
@kindex set history filename
11430
@kindex GDBHISTFILE
11431
@item set history filename @var{fname}
11432
Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11433
This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11434
list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11435
exits.  You can access this list through history expansion or through
11436
the history command editing characters listed below.  This file defaults
11437
to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
11438
@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11439
is not set.
11440
 
11441
@cindex history save
11442
@kindex set history save
11443
@item set history save
11444
@itemx set history save on
11445
Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11446
@code{set history filename} command.  By default, this option is disabled.
11447
 
11448
@item set history save off
11449
Stop recording command history in a file.
11450
 
11451
@cindex history size
11452
@kindex set history size
11453
@item set history size @var{size}
11454
Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11455
This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11456
@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11457
@end table
11458
 
11459
@cindex history expansion
11460
History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11461
@ifset have-readline-appendices
11462
@xref{Event Designators}.
11463
@end ifset
11464
 
11465
Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11466
is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11467
@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11468
follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11469
a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded.  The readline
11470
history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11471
@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11472
 
11473
The commands to control history expansion are:
11474
 
11475
@table @code
11476
@kindex set history expansion
11477
@item set history expansion on
11478
@itemx set history expansion
11479
Enable history expansion.  History expansion is off by default.
11480
 
11481
@item set history expansion off
11482
Disable history expansion.
11483
 
11484
The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11485
editing and history expansion features.  Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11486
or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11487
@ifset have-readline-appendices
11488
@xref{Command Line Editing}.
11489
@end ifset
11490
 
11491
@c @group
11492
@kindex show history
11493
@item show history
11494
@itemx show history filename
11495
@itemx show history save
11496
@itemx show history size
11497
@itemx show history expansion
11498
These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11499
@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11500
@c @end group
11501
@end table
11502
 
11503
@table @code
11504
@kindex shows
11505
@item show commands
11506
Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11507
 
11508
@item show commands @var{n}
11509
Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11510
 
11511
@item show commands +
11512
Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11513
@end table
11514
 
11515
@node Screen Size
11516
@section Screen size
11517
@cindex size of screen
11518
@cindex pauses in output
11519
 
11520
Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11521
information output to the screen.  To help you read all of it,
11522
@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11523
output.  Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11524
to discard the remaining output.  Also, the screen width setting
11525
determines when to wrap lines of output.  Depending on what is being
11526
printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11527
rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11528
 
11529
Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11530
driver software.  For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
11531
together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
11532
@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings.  If this is not correct,
11533
you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11534
width} commands:
11535
 
11536
@table @code
11537
@kindex set height
11538
@kindex set width
11539
@kindex show width
11540
@kindex show height
11541
@item set height @var{lpp}
11542
@itemx show height
11543
@itemx set width @var{cpl}
11544
@itemx show width
11545
These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11546
a screen width of @var{cpl} characters.  The associated @code{show}
11547
commands display the current settings.
11548
 
11549
If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11550
output no matter how long the output is.  This is useful if output is to a
11551
file or to an editor buffer.
11552
 
11553
Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11554
from wrapping its output.
11555
@end table
11556
 
11557
@node Numbers
11558
@section Numbers
11559
@cindex number representation
11560
@cindex entering numbers
11561
 
11562
You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11563
@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11564
@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11565
begin with @samp{0x}.  Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11566
default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11567
numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10.  You can
11568
change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11569
radix} command.
11570
 
11571
@table @code
11572
@kindex set input-radix
11573
@item set input-radix @var{base}
11574
Set the default base for numeric input.  Supported choices
11575
for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16.  @var{base} must itself be
11576
specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11577
example, any of
11578
 
11579
@smallexample
11580
set radix 012
11581
set radix 10.
11582
set radix 0xa
11583
@end smallexample
11584
 
11585
@noindent
11586
sets the base to decimal.  On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11587
leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11588
 
11589
@kindex set output-radix
11590
@item set output-radix @var{base}
11591
Set the default base for numeric display.  Supported choices
11592
for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16.  @var{base} must itself be
11593
specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11594
 
11595
@kindex show input-radix
11596
@item show input-radix
11597
Display the current default base for numeric input.
11598
 
11599
@kindex show output-radix
11600
@item show output-radix
11601
Display the current default base for numeric display.
11602
@end table
11603
 
11604
@node Messages/Warnings
11605
@section Optional warnings and messages
11606
 
11607
By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings.  If you are
11608
running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11609
command.  This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11610
internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
11611
 
11612
Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11613
which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11614
see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11615
 
11616
@table @code
11617
@kindex set verbose
11618
@item set verbose on
11619
Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11620
 
11621
@item set verbose off
11622
Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11623
 
11624
@kindex show verbose
11625
@item show verbose
11626
Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11627
@end table
11628
 
11629
By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11630
object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11631
find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11632
symbol files}).
11633
 
11634
@table @code
11635
 
11636
@kindex set complaints
11637
@item set complaints @var{limit}
11638
Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11639
unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem.  Set
11640
@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11641
to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
11642
 
11643
@kindex show complaints
11644
@item show complaints
11645
Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
11646
 
11647
@end table
11648
 
11649
By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11650
lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands.  For example, if
11651
you try to run a program which is already running:
11652
 
11653
@example
11654
(@value{GDBP}) run
11655
The program being debugged has been started already.
11656
Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11657
@end example
11658
 
11659
If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11660
commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11661
 
11662
@table @code
11663
 
11664
@kindex set confirm
11665
@cindex flinching
11666
@cindex confirmation
11667
@cindex stupid questions
11668
@item set confirm off
11669
Disables confirmation requests.
11670
 
11671
@item set confirm on
11672
Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11673
 
11674
@kindex show confirm
11675
@item show confirm
11676
Displays state of confirmation requests.
11677
 
11678
@end table
11679
 
11680
@node Debugging Output
11681
@section Optional messages about internal happenings
11682
@table @code
11683
@kindex set debug arch
11684
@item set debug arch
11685
Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
11686
@kindex show debug arch
11687
@item show debug arch
11688
Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
11689
@kindex set debug event
11690
@item set debug event
11691
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
11692
default is off.
11693
@kindex show debug event
11694
@item show debug event
11695
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
11696
info.
11697
@kindex set debug expression
11698
@item set debug expression
11699
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
11700
default is off.
11701
@kindex show debug expression
11702
@item show debug expression
11703
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
11704
debugging info.
11705
@kindex set debug overload
11706
@item set debug overload
11707
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C++ overload debugging
11708
info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
11709
is off.
11710
@kindex show debug overload
11711
@item show debug overload
11712
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C++ overload
11713
debugging info.
11714
@kindex set debug remote
11715
@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
11716
@cindex serial connections, debugging
11717
@item set debug remote
11718
Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
11719
the serial line to the remote machine.  The info is printed on the
11720
@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
11721
@kindex show debug remote
11722
@item show debug remote
11723
Displays the state of display of remote packets.
11724
@kindex set debug serial
11725
@item set debug serial
11726
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
11727
default is off.
11728
@kindex show debug serial
11729
@item show debug serial
11730
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
11731
info.
11732
@kindex set debug target
11733
@item set debug target
11734
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
11735
includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
11736
default is off.
11737
@kindex show debug target
11738
@item show debug target
11739
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
11740
info.
11741
@kindex set debug varobj
11742
@item set debug varobj
11743
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
11744
info. The default is off.
11745
@kindex show debug varobj
11746
@item show debug varobj
11747
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
11748
debugging info.
11749
@end table
11750
 
11751
@node Sequences
11752
@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11753
 
11754
Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
11755
command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11756
commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11757
files.
11758
 
11759
@menu
11760
* Define::                      User-defined commands
11761
* Hooks::                       User-defined command hooks
11762
* Command Files::               Command files
11763
* Output::                      Commands for controlled output
11764
@end menu
11765
 
11766
@node Define
11767
@section User-defined commands
11768
 
11769
@cindex user-defined command
11770
A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11771
which you assign a new name as a command.  This is done with the
11772
@code{define} command.  User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11773
separated by whitespace.  Arguments are accessed within the user command
11774
via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}.  A trivial example:
11775
 
11776
@smallexample
11777
define adder
11778
  print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11779
@end smallexample
11780
 
11781
@noindent
11782
To execute the command use:
11783
 
11784
@smallexample
11785
adder 1 2 3
11786
@end smallexample
11787
 
11788
@noindent
11789
This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
11790
its three arguments.  Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
11791
reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11792
functions calls.
11793
 
11794
@table @code
11795
 
11796
@kindex define
11797
@item define @var{commandname}
11798
Define a command named @var{commandname}.  If there is already a command
11799
by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11800
 
11801
The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11802
which are given following the @code{define} command.  The end of these
11803
commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11804
 
11805
@kindex if
11806
@kindex else
11807
@item if
11808
Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11809
It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11810
only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11811
There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11812
by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11813
was false.  The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11814
 
11815
@kindex while
11816
@item while
11817
The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11818
which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11819
execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11820
The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11821
evaluates to true.
11822
 
11823
@kindex document
11824
@item document @var{commandname}
11825
Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
11826
accessed by @code{help}.  The command @var{commandname} must already be
11827
defined.  This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11828
reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11829
After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
11830
@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11831
 
11832
You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11833
documentation of a command.  Redefining the command with @code{define}
11834
does not change the documentation.
11835
 
11836
@kindex help user-defined
11837
@item help user-defined
11838
List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11839
(if any) for each.
11840
 
11841
@kindex show user
11842
@item show user
11843
@itemx show user @var{commandname}
11844
Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
11845
not its documentation).  If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
11846
definitions for all user-defined commands.
11847
 
11848
@end table
11849
 
11850
When user-defined commands are executed, the
11851
commands of the definition are not printed.  An error in any command
11852
stops execution of the user-defined command.
11853
 
11854
If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
11855
without asking when used inside a user-defined command.  Many @value{GDBN}
11856
commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
11857
messages when used in a user-defined command.
11858
 
11859
@node Hooks
11860
@section User-defined command hooks
11861
@cindex command hooks
11862
@cindex hooks, for commands
11863
 
11864
You may define @emph{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
11865
command.  Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
11866
command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
11867
before that command.
11868
 
11869
@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
11870
In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists.  Defining
11871
(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
11872
execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
11873
displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
11874
 
11875
For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
11876
single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
11877
you could define:
11878
 
11879
@example
11880
define hook-stop
11881
handle SIGALRM nopass
11882
end
11883
 
11884
define hook-run
11885
handle SIGALRM pass
11886
end
11887
 
11888
define hook-continue
11889
handle SIGLARM pass
11890
end
11891
@end example
11892
 
11893
You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
11894
not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
11895
name, e.g.  @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
11896
@c FIXME!  So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
11897
@c or not?
11898
If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
11899
@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
11900
(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
11901
 
11902
If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
11903
get a warning from the @code{define} command.
11904
 
11905
@node Command Files
11906
@section Command files
11907
 
11908
@cindex command files
11909
A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
11910
commands.  Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
11911
An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
11912
the last command, as it would from the terminal.
11913
 
11914
@cindex init file
11915
@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
11916
@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
11917
When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
11918
@dfn{init files}.  These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix, or
11919
@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows.  @value{GDBN} reads the init file (if
11920
any) in your home directory@footnote{On DOS/Windows systems, the home
11921
directory is the one pointed to by the @code{HOME} environment
11922
variable.}, then processes command line options and operands, and then
11923
reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.  This is
11924
so the init file in your home directory can set options (such as
11925
@code{set complaints}) which affect the processing of the command line
11926
options and operands.  The init files are not executed if you use the
11927
@samp{-nx} option; @pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}.
11928
 
11929
@cindex init file name
11930
On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
11931
different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
11932
form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
11933
different name for the specialized version's init file).  These are the
11934
environments with special init file names:
11935
 
11936
@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
11937
@itemize @bullet
11938
@item
11939
VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
11940
 
11941
@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
11942
@item
11943
OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
11944
 
11945
@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
11946
@item
11947
ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
11948
@end itemize
11949
 
11950
You can also request the execution of a command file with the
11951
@code{source} command:
11952
 
11953
@table @code
11954
@kindex source
11955
@item source @var{filename}
11956
Execute the command file @var{filename}.
11957
@end table
11958
 
11959
The lines in a command file are executed sequentially.  They are not
11960
printed as they are executed.  An error in any command terminates execution
11961
of the command file.
11962
 
11963
Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
11964
without asking when used in a command file.  Many @value{GDBN} commands that
11965
normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
11966
when called from command files.
11967
 
11968
@node Output
11969
@section Commands for controlled output
11970
 
11971
During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
11972
@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
11973
explicitly printed by the commands in the definition.  This section
11974
describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
11975
want.
11976
 
11977
@table @code
11978
@kindex echo
11979
@item echo @var{text}
11980
@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
11981
@c because it is not in ANSI.
11982
Print @var{text}.  Nonprinting characters can be included in
11983
@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
11984
newline.  @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
11985
In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
11986
by a space stands for a space.  This is useful for displaying a
11987
string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
11988
trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
11989
To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
11990
@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
11991
 
11992
A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
11993
the command onto subsequent lines.  For example,
11994
 
11995
@example
11996
echo This is some text\n\
11997
which is continued\n\
11998
onto several lines.\n
11999
@end example
12000
 
12001
produces the same output as
12002
 
12003
@example
12004
echo This is some text\n
12005
echo which is continued\n
12006
echo onto several lines.\n
12007
@end example
12008
 
12009
@kindex output
12010
@item output @var{expression}
12011
Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12012
newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }.  The value is not entered in the
12013
value history either.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
12014
on expressions.
12015
 
12016
@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12017
Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}.  You can use
12018
the same formats as for @code{print}.  @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12019
formats}, for more information.
12020
 
12021
@kindex printf
12022
@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12023
Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12024
@var{string}.  The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12025
either numbers or pointers.  Their values are printed as specified by
12026
@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12027
subroutine
12028
@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12029
@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12030
@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12031
@c supported.
12032
 
12033
@example
12034
printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12035
@end example
12036
 
12037
For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12038
 
12039
@smallexample
12040
printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12041
@end smallexample
12042
 
12043
The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12044
string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12045
letter.
12046
@end table
12047
 
12048
@node Emacs
12049
@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12050
 
12051
@cindex Emacs
12052
@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12053
A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12054
edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12055
@value{GDBN}.
12056
 
12057
To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs.  Give the
12058
executable file you want to debug as an argument.  This command starts
12059
@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12060
created Emacs buffer.
12061
@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
12062
 
12063
Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12064
things:
12065
 
12066
@itemize @bullet
12067
@item
12068
All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12069
@end itemize
12070
 
12071
This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
12072
and output done by the program you are debugging.
12073
 
12074
This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
12075
commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
12076
in this way.
12077
 
12078
All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
12079
with your program.  In particular, you can send signals the usual
12080
way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
12081
stop.
12082
 
12083
@itemize @bullet
12084
@item
12085
@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
12086
@end itemize
12087
 
12088
Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
12089
source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
12090
left margin of the current line.  Emacs uses a separate buffer for
12091
source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
12092
and the source.
12093
 
12094
Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
12095
usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
12096
 
12097
@quotation
12098
@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
12099
current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
12100
the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
12101
appear to show your source.  @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
12102
environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
12103
session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
12104
back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation.  To
12105
avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
12106
your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
12107
@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
12108
 
12109
A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
12110
switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
12111
@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
12112
@end quotation
12113
 
12114
By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}.  If
12115
you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
12116
several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
12117
Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
12118
 
12119
@example
12120
(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
12121
@end example
12122
 
12123
@noindent
12124
(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
12125
in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
12126
``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
12127
 
12128
In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
12129
addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
12130
 
12131
@table @kbd
12132
@item C-h m
12133
Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
12134
 
12135
@item M-s
12136
Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
12137
update the display window to show the current file and location.
12138
 
12139
@item M-n
12140
Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
12141
calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command.  Then update the display window
12142
to show the current file and location.
12143
 
12144
@item M-i
12145
Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
12146
display window accordingly.
12147
 
12148
@item M-x gdb-nexti
12149
Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
12150
display window accordingly.
12151
 
12152
@item C-c C-f
12153
Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
12154
@code{finish} command.
12155
 
12156
@item M-c
12157
Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
12158
command.
12159
 
12160
@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
12161
 
12162
@item M-u
12163
Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
12164
(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
12165
like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
12166
 
12167
@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
12168
 
12169
@item M-d
12170
Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
12171
@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
12172
 
12173
@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
12174
 
12175
@item C-x &
12176
Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
12177
of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer.  For example, if you wish to disassemble code
12178
around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
12179
then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
12180
argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
12181
 
12182
You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
12183
@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
12184
otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
12185
inserted.  A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
12186
wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
12187
list.  If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
12188
formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
12189
is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
12190
@end table
12191
 
12192
In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
12193
tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
12194
 
12195
If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
12196
it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
12197
request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
12198
the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
12199
frame.
12200
 
12201
The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
12202
which are visiting the source files in the usual way.  You can edit
12203
the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
12204
communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers.  If you add or
12205
delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
12206
to correspond properly with the code.
12207
 
12208
@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard.  Reactivate
12209
@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
12210
@ignore
12211
@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
12212
@kindex Epoch
12213
@kindex inspect
12214
 
12215
Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
12216
called the @code{epoch}
12217
environment.  Users of this environment can use a new command,
12218
@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
12219
each value is printed in its own window.
12220
@end ignore
12221
 
12222
@include annotate.texi
12223
@include gdbmi.texinfo
12224
 
12225
@node GDB Bugs
12226
@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
12227
@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
12228
@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
12229
 
12230
Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
12231
 
12232
Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
12233
may not.  But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
12234
the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better.  Bug
12235
reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
12236
 
12237
In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
12238
information that enables us to fix the bug.
12239
 
12240
@menu
12241
* Bug Criteria::                Have you found a bug?
12242
* Bug Reporting::               How to report bugs
12243
@end menu
12244
 
12245
@node Bug Criteria
12246
@section Have you found a bug?
12247
@cindex bug criteria
12248
 
12249
If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
12250
 
12251
@itemize @bullet
12252
@cindex fatal signal
12253
@cindex debugger crash
12254
@cindex crash of debugger
12255
@item
12256
If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
12257
@value{GDBN} bug.  Reliable debuggers never crash.
12258
 
12259
@cindex error on valid input
12260
@item
12261
If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
12262
bug.  (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
12263
somewhere in the connection to the target.)
12264
 
12265
@cindex invalid input
12266
@item
12267
If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
12268
that is a bug.  However, you should note that your idea of
12269
``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
12270
for traditional practice''.
12271
 
12272
@item
12273
If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
12274
for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
12275
@end itemize
12276
 
12277
@node Bug Reporting
12278
@section How to report bugs
12279
@cindex bug reports
12280
@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
12281
 
12282
A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
12283
If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
12284
contact that organization first.
12285
 
12286
You can find contact information for many support companies and
12287
individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
12288
distribution.
12289
@c should add a web page ref...
12290
 
12291
In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
12292
@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
12293
 
12294
@example
12295
bug-gdb@@gnu.org
12296
@end example
12297
 
12298
@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
12299
@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.}  Most users of @value{GDBN} do
12300
not want to receive bug reports.  Those that do have arranged to receive
12301
@samp{bug-gdb}.
12302
 
12303
The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
12304
serves as a repeater.  The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
12305
the same messages.  Often people think of posting bug reports to the
12306
newsgroup instead of mailing them.  This appears to work, but it has one
12307
problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
12308
path back to the sender.  Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
12309
we may be unable to reach you.  For this reason, it is better to send
12310
bug reports to the mailing list.
12311
 
12312
As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
12313
 
12314
@example
12315
@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
12316
Free Software Foundation Inc.
12317
59 Temple Place - Suite 330
12318
Boston, MA 02111-1307
12319
USA
12320
@end example
12321
 
12322
The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
12323
@strong{report all the facts}.  If you are not sure whether to state a
12324
fact or leave it out, state it!
12325
 
12326
Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
12327
problem and assume that some details do not matter.  Thus, you might
12328
assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
12329
Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure.  Perhaps the bug is a
12330
stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
12331
name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
12332
of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
12333
the bug.  Play it safe and give a specific, complete example.  That is the
12334
easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
12335
 
12336
Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
12337
bug.  It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
12338
you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
12339
self-contained.
12340
 
12341
Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
12342
bell?''  Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
12343
@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
12344
bugs properly.
12345
 
12346
To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
12347
 
12348
@itemize @bullet
12349
@item
12350
The version of @value{GDBN}.  @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
12351
with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
12352
version}.
12353
 
12354
Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
12355
the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
12356
 
12357
@item
12358
The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
12359
version number.
12360
 
12361
@item
12362
What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
12363
``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
12364
 
12365
@item
12366
What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
12367
debugging---e.g.  ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
12368
C Compiler''.  For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12369
information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12370
compilers.
12371
 
12372
@item
12373
The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12374
observe the bug.  For example, did you use @samp{-O}?  To guarantee
12375
you will not omit something important, list them all.  A copy of the
12376
Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12377
 
12378
If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12379
and then we might not encounter the bug.
12380
 
12381
@item
12382
A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12383
reproduce the bug.
12384
 
12385
@item
12386
A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12387
incorrect.  For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12388
 
12389
Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12390
will certainly notice it.  But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12391
not notice unless it is glaringly wrong.  You might as well not give us
12392
a chance to make a mistake.
12393
 
12394
Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12395
say so explicitly.  Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12396
copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12397
the C library on your system.  (This has happened!)  Your copy might
12398
crash and ours would not.  If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12399
ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12400
us.  If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12401
to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12402
 
12403
@item
12404
If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12405
diffs.  If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12406
it by context, not by line number.
12407
 
12408
The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12409
sources.  Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
12410
 
12411
@end itemize
12412
 
12413
Here are some things that are not necessary:
12414
 
12415
@itemize @bullet
12416
@item
12417
A description of the envelope of the bug.
12418
 
12419
Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12420
which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12421
changes will not affect it.
12422
 
12423
This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12424
will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12425
with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12426
We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12427
 
12428
Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12429
of the original one, that is a convenience for us.  Errors in the
12430
output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12431
less time, and so on.
12432
 
12433
However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12434
report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12435
 
12436
@item
12437
A patch for the bug.
12438
 
12439
A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one.  But do not omit
12440
the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12441
a patch is all we need.  We might see problems with your patch and decide
12442
to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12443
 
12444
Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12445
construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12446
through the code.  If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12447
to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12448
 
12449
And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12450
patch should be an improvement, we will not install it.  A test case will
12451
help us to understand.
12452
 
12453
@item
12454
A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12455
 
12456
Such guesses are usually wrong.  Even we cannot guess right about such
12457
things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12458
@end itemize
12459
 
12460
@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
12461
@c and consists of the two following files:
12462
@c     rluser.texinfo
12463
@c     inc-hist.texinfo
12464
@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12465
@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12466
@include rluser.texinfo
12467
@include inc-hist.texinfo
12468
 
12469
 
12470
@node Formatting Documentation
12471
@appendix Formatting Documentation
12472
 
12473
@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12474
@cindex reference card
12475
The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12476
for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12477
subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12478
@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12479
release.}.  If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12480
you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12481
 
12482
The release also includes the source for the reference card.  You
12483
can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12484
 
12485
@example
12486
make refcard.dvi
12487
@end example
12488
 
12489
The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12490
mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
12491
that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12492
high.  You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12493
your @sc{dvi} output program.
12494
 
12495
@cindex documentation
12496
 
12497
All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12498
distribution.  The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12499
a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12500
on-line information and a printed manual.  You can use one of the Info
12501
formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12502
and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12503
 
12504
@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12505
version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory.  The main Info
12506
file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12507
subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory.  If
12508
necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12509
but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12510
Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12511
@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12512
 
12513
If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12514
Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12515
@code{makeinfo}.
12516
 
12517
If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12518
@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12519
version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12520
 
12521
@example
12522
cd gdb
12523
make gdb.info
12524
@end example
12525
 
12526
If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12527
a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12528
Texinfo definitions file.
12529
 
12530
@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12531
produces output files called @sc{dvi} files.  To print a typeset
12532
document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files.  If your system
12533
has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program.  The precise
12534
command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12535
(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}.  The @sc{dvi} print command may
12536
require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12537
 
12538
@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12539
@file{texinfo.tex}.  This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12540
written in Texinfo format.  On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12541
typeset a Texinfo file.  @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12542
and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12543
directory.
12544
 
12545
If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12546
typeset and print this manual.  First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12547
subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12548
@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12549
 
12550
@example
12551
make gdb.dvi
12552
@end example
12553
 
12554
Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
12555
 
12556
@node Installing GDB
12557
@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12558
@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12559
@cindex installation
12560
 
12561
@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12562
of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12563
build the @code{gdb} program.
12564
@iftex
12565
@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12566
@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12567
look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12568
installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12569
@end iftex
12570
 
12571
The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12572
@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
12573
appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12574
 
12575
For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12576
@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.  That directory contains:
12577
 
12578
@table @code
12579
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12580
script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12581
 
12582
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12583
the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12584
 
12585
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12586
source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12587
 
12588
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12589
@sc{gnu} include files
12590
 
12591
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12592
source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12593
 
12594
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12595
source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12596
 
12597
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12598
source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12599
 
12600
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12601
source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12602
 
12603
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12604
source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12605
@end table
12606
 
12607
The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12608
from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12609
this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12610
 
12611
First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12612
if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}.  Pass the
12613
identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12614
argument.
12615
 
12616
For example:
12617
 
12618
@example
12619
cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12620
./configure @var{host}
12621
make
12622
@end example
12623
 
12624
@noindent
12625
where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12626
@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12627
(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12628
correct value by examining your system.)
12629
 
12630
Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12631
@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12632
libraries, then @code{gdb} itself.  The configured source files, and the
12633
binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12634
 
12635
@need 750
12636
@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12637
system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12638
shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12639
 
12640
@example
12641
sh configure @var{host}
12642
@end example
12643
 
12644
If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12645
directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12646
@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12647
creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12648
you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12649
 
12650
You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12651
subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12652
configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12653
 
12654
For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12655
the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12656
 
12657
@example
12658
@group
12659
cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12660
../configure @var{host}
12661
@end group
12662
@end example
12663
 
12664
You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12665
However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12666
the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable.  Remember
12667
that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12668
let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12669
 
12670
@menu
12671
* Separate Objdir::             Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12672
* Config Names::                Specifying names for hosts and targets
12673
* Configure Options::           Summary of options for configure
12674
@end menu
12675
 
12676
@node Separate Objdir
12677
@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12678
 
12679
If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12680
you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12681
host and target.  @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12682
allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12683
rather than in the source directory.  If your @code{make} program
12684
handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12685
@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12686
program specified there.
12687
 
12688
To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12689
with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12690
(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12691
itself from your working directory.  If the path to @code{configure}
12692
would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12693
the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12694
 
12695
For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
12696
separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12697
 
12698
@example
12699
@group
12700
cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12701
mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12702
cd ../gdb-sun4
12703
../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12704
make
12705
@end group
12706
@end example
12707
 
12708
When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12709
directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12710
(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory.  In
12711
the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12712
directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12713
@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12714
 
12715
One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
12716
directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12717
@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12718
programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
12719
You specify a cross-debugging target by
12720
giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12721
 
12722
When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12723
it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12724
called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12725
 
12726
The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12727
directory also runs recursively.  If you type @code{make} in a source
12728
directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12729
directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12730
will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12731
 
12732
When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12733
directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12734
if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12735
with each other.
12736
 
12737
@node Config Names
12738
@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12739
 
12740
The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12741
script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12742
aliases are also supported.  The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12743
of information in the following pattern:
12744
 
12745
@example
12746
@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12747
@end example
12748
 
12749
For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12750
or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12751
option.  The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12752
 
12753
The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12754
any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12755
aliases.  @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12756
@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12757
script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12758
abbreviations---for example:
12759
 
12760
@smallexample
12761
% sh config.sub i386-linux
12762
i386-pc-linux-gnu
12763
% sh config.sub alpha-linux
12764
alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12765
% sh config.sub hp9k700
12766
hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12767
% sh config.sub sun4
12768
sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12769
% sh config.sub sun3
12770
m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12771
% sh config.sub i986v
12772
Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12773
@end smallexample
12774
 
12775
@noindent
12776
@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12777
directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12778
 
12779
@node Configure Options
12780
@section @code{configure} options
12781
 
12782
Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12783
are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}.  @code{configure} also has
12784
several other options not listed here.  @inforef{What Configure
12785
Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12786
 
12787
@example
12788
configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12789
          @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12790
          @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12791
          @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12792
          @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12793
          @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12794
          @var{host}
12795
@end example
12796
 
12797
@noindent
12798
You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12799
@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12800
@samp{--}.
12801
 
12802
@table @code
12803
@item --help
12804
Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
12805
 
12806
@item --prefix=@var{dir}
12807
Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
12808
@file{@var{dir}}.
12809
 
12810
@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
12811
Configure the source to install programs under directory
12812
@file{@var{dir}}.
12813
 
12814
@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
12815
@need 2000
12816
@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
12817
@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
12818
@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
12819
Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
12820
@value{GDBN} source directories.  Among other things, you can use this to
12821
build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
12822
directories.  @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
12823
the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
12824
directory @var{dirname}.  @code{configure} creates directories under
12825
the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
12826
@var{dirname}.
12827
 
12828
@item --norecursion
12829
Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
12830
propagate configuration to subdirectories.
12831
 
12832
@item --target=@var{target}
12833
Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
12834
@var{target}.  Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
12835
programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
12836
 
12837
There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
12838
 
12839
@item @var{host} @dots{}
12840
Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
12841
 
12842
There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
12843
@end table
12844
 
12845
There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
12846
needed for special purposes only.
12847
 
12848
@node Index
12849
@unnumbered Index
12850
 
12851
@printindex cp
12852
 
12853
@tex
12854
% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo.  In the
12855
% meantime:
12856
\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
12857
\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
12858
\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
12859
\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
12860
\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
12861
\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
12862
\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
12863
\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
12864
\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
12865
\page\colophon
12866
% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
12867
@end tex
12868
 
12869
@contents
12870
@bye

powered by: WebSVN 2.1.0

© copyright 1999-2024 OpenCores.org, equivalent to Oliscience, all rights reserved. OpenCores®, registered trademark.